gdb/
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
131
132 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
133
134 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
135
136 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
137
138 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
139
140 static void commands_command (char *, int);
141
142 static void condition_command (char *, int);
143
144 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
145
146 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
147
148 typedef enum
149 {
150 mark_inserted,
151 mark_uninserted
152 }
153 insertion_state_t;
154
155 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
157
158 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
159
160 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
161
162 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
163
164 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
165
166 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
167
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
169
170 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
171
172 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
173
174 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
175
176 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
177
178 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
179
180 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
181
182 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
183
184 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
185
186 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
189
190 static char *ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg);
191
192 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
193 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
194
195 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
196
197 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
198
199 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
200 CORE_ADDR pc);
201
202 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
203
204 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
205
206 static void update_global_location_list (int);
207
208 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
209
210 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
211
212 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
213
214 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
215
216 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
217
218 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
219
220 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
221
222 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
223
224 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
225
226 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
227
228
229 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
230 current breakpoint. */
231
232 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
233
234 static const char *
235 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
236 {
237 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
238 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
239 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
240 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
241 }
242
243 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
244 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
245 if such is available. */
246 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
247
248 static void
249 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
250 struct cmd_list_element *c,
251 const char *value)
252 {
253 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
254 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
255 value);
256 }
257
258 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
259 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
260 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
261 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
262 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
263 static void
264 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
265 struct cmd_list_element *c,
266 const char *value)
267 {
268 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
269 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
270 value);
271 }
272
273 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
274 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
275 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
276 use hardware breakpoints. */
277 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
278 static void
279 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
280 struct cmd_list_element *c,
281 const char *value)
282 {
283 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
284 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
285 value);
286 }
287
288 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
289 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
290 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
291 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
292 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
293
294 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
295 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
296 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
297 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
298 always_inserted_auto,
299 always_inserted_off,
300 always_inserted_on,
301 NULL
302 };
303 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
304 static void
305 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
306 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
307 {
308 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
309 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
310 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
311 value,
312 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
313 else
314 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
315 }
316
317 int
318 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
319 {
320 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
321 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
322 }
323
324 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
325
326 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
327 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
328
329 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
330 static int overlay_events_enabled;
331
332 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
333 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
334 breakpoint. */
335
336 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
337
338 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
339 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
340 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
341 B = TMP)
342
343 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
344 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
345 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
346
347 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
348 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
349 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
350 BP_TMP++)
351
352 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
353
354 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
355 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
356 if ((B)->type == bp_tracepoint)
357
358 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
359
360 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
361
362 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
363
364 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
365
366 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
367
368 static unsigned bp_location_count;
369
370 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
371 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
372 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
373 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
374
375 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
376
377 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
378 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
379 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
380 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
381 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
382
383 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
384
385 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
386 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
387 may still be reported by a target. */
388 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
389
390 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
391
392 int breakpoint_count;
393
394 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
395
396 int tracepoint_count;
397
398 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
399 static int
400 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
401 {
402 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
403 }
404
405 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
406
407 void
408 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
409 {
410 breakpoint_count = num;
411 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
412 }
413
414 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
415
416 void
417 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
418 {
419 struct breakpoint *b;
420
421 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
422 b->hit_count = 0;
423 }
424
425 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
426 for "break" command with no arg.
427 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
428 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
429
430 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
431
432 int default_breakpoint_valid;
433 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
434 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
435 int default_breakpoint_line;
436 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
437
438 \f
439 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
440 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
441
442 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
443 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
444 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
445
446 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
447
448 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
449 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
450 static int
451 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
452 {
453 int retval = 0; /* default */
454 char *p = *pp;
455
456 if (p == NULL)
457 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
458 return breakpoint_count;
459 else if (*p == '$')
460 {
461 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
462 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
463 char *varname;
464 char *start = ++p;
465 LONGEST val;
466
467 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
468 p++;
469 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
470 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
471 varname[p - start] = '\0';
472 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
473 retval = (int) val;
474 else
475 {
476 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
477 retval = 0;
478 }
479 }
480 else
481 {
482 if (*p == '-')
483 ++p;
484 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
485 ++p;
486 if (p == *pp)
487 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
488 {
489 /* Skip non-numeric token */
490 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
491 ++p;
492 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
493 retval = 0;
494 }
495 else
496 retval = atoi (*pp);
497 }
498 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
499 {
500 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
501 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
502 ++p;
503 retval = 0;
504 }
505 while (isspace (*p))
506 p++;
507 *pp = p;
508 return retval;
509 }
510
511
512 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
513 int
514 get_number (char **pp)
515 {
516 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
517 }
518
519 /* Parse a number or a range.
520 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
521 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
522 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
523 * inclusive.
524 *
525 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
526 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
527 *
528 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
529 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
530 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
531 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
532 * pointer PP past <number2>.
533 */
534
535 int
536 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
537 {
538 static int last_retval, end_value;
539 static char *end_ptr;
540 static int in_range = 0;
541
542 if (**pp != '-')
543 {
544 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
545 or to the first number of a range. */
546 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
547 if (**pp == '-')
548 {
549 char **temp;
550
551 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
552 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
553 and also remember the end of the final token. */
554
555 temp = &end_ptr;
556 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
557 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
558 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
559 end_value = get_number (temp);
560 if (end_value < last_retval)
561 {
562 error (_("inverted range"));
563 }
564 else if (end_value == last_retval)
565 {
566 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
567 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
568 single number. */
569 *pp = end_ptr;
570 }
571 else
572 in_range = 1;
573 }
574 }
575 else if (! in_range)
576 error (_("negative value"));
577 else
578 {
579 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
580 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
581 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
582 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
583 is reached. */
584
585 if (++last_retval == end_value)
586 {
587 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
588 *pp = end_ptr;
589 in_range = 0;
590 }
591 }
592 return last_retval;
593 }
594
595 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
596 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
597
598 struct breakpoint *
599 get_breakpoint (int num)
600 {
601 struct breakpoint *b;
602
603 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
604 if (b->number == num)
605 return b;
606
607 return NULL;
608 }
609
610 \f
611 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
612
613 static void
614 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
615 {
616 struct breakpoint *b;
617 char *p;
618 int bnum;
619
620 if (arg == 0)
621 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
622
623 p = arg;
624 bnum = get_number (&p);
625 if (bnum == 0)
626 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
627
628 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
629 if (b->number == bnum)
630 {
631 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
632 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
633 {
634 if (loc->cond)
635 {
636 xfree (loc->cond);
637 loc->cond = 0;
638 }
639 }
640 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
641 xfree (b->cond_string);
642
643 if (*p == 0)
644 {
645 b->cond_string = NULL;
646 if (from_tty)
647 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
648 }
649 else
650 {
651 arg = p;
652 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
653 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
654 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
655 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
656 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
657 {
658 arg = p;
659 loc->cond =
660 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
661 if (*arg)
662 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
663 }
664 }
665 breakpoints_changed ();
666 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
667 return;
668 }
669
670 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
671 }
672
673 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
674
675 void
676 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
677 {
678 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
679 b->commands = commands;
680 breakpoints_changed ();
681 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
682 }
683
684 static void
685 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
686 {
687 struct breakpoint *b;
688 char *p;
689 int bnum;
690 struct command_line *l;
691
692 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
693 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
694 being read from. */
695
696 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
697 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
698
699 p = arg;
700 bnum = get_number (&p);
701
702 if (p && *p)
703 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
704
705 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
706 if (b->number == bnum)
707 {
708 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
709 bnum);
710 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
711 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
712 do_cleanups (cleanups);
713 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
714 return;
715 }
716 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
717 }
718
719 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
720 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
721
722 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
723 that are part of if and while bodies. */
724 enum command_control_type
725 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
726 {
727 struct breakpoint *b;
728 char *p;
729 int bnum;
730
731 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
732 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
733 being read from. */
734
735 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
736 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
737
738 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
739 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
740 if (arg && !*arg)
741 p = NULL;
742 else
743 p = arg;
744 bnum = get_number (&p);
745
746 if (p && *p)
747 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
748
749 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
750 if (b->number == bnum)
751 {
752 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
753 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
754 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
755 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
756 list after it finishes execution. */
757 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
758 breakpoints_changed ();
759 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
760 return simple_control;
761 }
762 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
763 }
764
765 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
766
767 static int
768 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
769 {
770 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
771 return 0;
772 if (!bl->inserted)
773 return 0;
774 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
775 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
776 return 0;
777 return 1;
778 }
779
780 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
781 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
782
783 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
784 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
785 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
786 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
787 memaddr ... memaddr + len
788 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
789 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
790 and:
791 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
792
793 void
794 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
795 {
796 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
797 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
798
799 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
800 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
801
802 bc_l = 0;
803 bc_r = bp_location_count;
804 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
805 {
806 struct bp_location *b;
807
808 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
809 b = bp_location[bc];
810
811 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
812 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
813 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
814
815 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
816 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
817 MEMADDR. */
818
819 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
820 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
821 bc_l = bc;
822 else
823 bc_r = bc;
824 }
825
826 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
827
828 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
829 {
830 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
831 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
832 int bp_size = 0;
833 int bptoffset = 0;
834
835 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
836 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
837 b->owner->number);
838
839 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
840 content. */
841
842 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
843 && memaddr + len <= b->address
844 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
845 break;
846
847 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
848 continue;
849 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
850 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
851 continue;
852
853 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
854 we need to copy. */
855 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
856 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
857
858 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
859 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
860 are reading. */
861 continue;
862
863 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
864 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
865 reading. */
866 continue;
867
868 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
869 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
870 {
871 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
872 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
873 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
874 bp_addr = memaddr;
875 }
876
877 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
878 {
879 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
880 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
881 }
882
883 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
884 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
885 }
886 }
887 \f
888
889 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
890 static void
891 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
892 {
893 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
894 int val = -1;
895
896 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
897 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
898
899 b->ops->insert (b);
900 }
901
902 static int
903 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
904 {
905 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
906 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
907 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
908 }
909
910 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
911 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
912 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
913 not need them.
914
915 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
916 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
917 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
918 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
919 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
920
921 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
922 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
923 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
924 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
925
926 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
927 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
928 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
929 chain. */
930
931 static void
932 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
933 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
934 {
935 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
936 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
937
938 *valp = NULL;
939 if (resultp)
940 *resultp = NULL;
941 if (val_chain)
942 *val_chain = NULL;
943
944 /* Evaluate the expression. */
945 mark = value_mark ();
946 result = NULL;
947
948 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
949 {
950 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
951 }
952 if (ex.reason < 0)
953 {
954 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
955 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
956 error to some higher catcher. */
957 switch (ex.error)
958 {
959 case MEMORY_ERROR:
960 break;
961 default:
962 throw_exception (ex);
963 break;
964 }
965 }
966
967 new_mark = value_mark ();
968 if (mark == new_mark)
969 return;
970 if (resultp)
971 *resultp = result;
972
973 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
974 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
975 if (result != NULL
976 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
977 *valp = result;
978
979 if (val_chain)
980 {
981 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
982 decide which addresses to watch. */
983 *val_chain = new_mark;
984 value_release_to_mark (mark);
985 }
986 }
987
988 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
989 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
990 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
991 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
992 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
993 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
994 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
995 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
996 running. */
997
998 static int
999 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1000 {
1001 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1002 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1003 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1004 }
1005
1006 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1007 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1008 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1009 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1010 in b->loc->cond.
1011 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1012
1013 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1014 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1015
1016 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1017 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1018 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1019 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1020 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1021 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1022 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1023
1024 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1025 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1026 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1027 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1028 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1029 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1030 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1031 memory content has not changed.
1032
1033 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1034 watchpoints:
1035
1036 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1037 several times when GDB stops.
1038
1039 [linux]
1040 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1041 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1042 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1043 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1044 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1045 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1046 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1047 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1048 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1049 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1050
1051 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1052 removal from inferior. */
1053
1054 static void
1055 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1056 {
1057 int within_current_scope;
1058 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1059 struct bp_location *loc;
1060 int frame_saved;
1061 bpstat bs;
1062
1063 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1064 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1065 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1066 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1067 return;
1068
1069 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1070 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1071 breakpoints if needed. */
1072 b->loc = NULL;
1073
1074 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1075 return;
1076
1077 frame_saved = 0;
1078
1079 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1080 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1081 within_current_scope = 1;
1082 else
1083 {
1084 struct frame_info *fi;
1085
1086 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1087 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1088 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1089 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1090 selected frame. */
1091 frame_saved = 1;
1092 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1093
1094 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1095 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1096 if (within_current_scope)
1097 select_frame (fi);
1098 }
1099
1100 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1101 {
1102 char *s;
1103 if (b->exp)
1104 {
1105 xfree (b->exp);
1106 b->exp = NULL;
1107 }
1108 s = b->exp_string;
1109 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1110 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1111 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1112 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1113 be completely different objects. */
1114 value_free (b->val);
1115 b->val = NULL;
1116 b->val_valid = 0;
1117 }
1118
1119 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1120 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1121 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1122 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1123 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1124 if ( !target_has_execution)
1125 {
1126 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1127 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1128 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1129 }
1130 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1131 {
1132 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1133 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1134
1135 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1136
1137 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1138 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1139 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1140 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1141 if (!b->val_valid)
1142 {
1143 b->val = v;
1144 b->val_valid = 1;
1145 }
1146
1147 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1148 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1149 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1150 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1151 && reparse)
1152 {
1153 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1154
1155 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1156 &other_type_used);
1157 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1158
1159 if (!mem_cnt)
1160 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1161 else
1162 {
1163 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1164 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1165 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1166 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1167 else
1168 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1169 }
1170 }
1171
1172 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1173
1174 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1175 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1176 {
1177 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1178 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1179 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1180 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1181 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1182 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1183 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1184 {
1185 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1186
1187 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1188 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1189 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1190 if (v == result
1191 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1192 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1193 {
1194 CORE_ADDR addr;
1195 int len, type;
1196 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1197
1198 addr = value_address (v);
1199 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1200 type = hw_write;
1201 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1202 type = hw_read;
1203 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1204 type = hw_access;
1205
1206 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1207 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1208 ;
1209 *tmp = loc;
1210 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1211
1212 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1213 loc->address = addr;
1214 loc->length = len;
1215 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1216 }
1217 }
1218
1219 next = value_next (v);
1220 if (v != b->val)
1221 value_free (v);
1222 }
1223
1224 /* We just regenerated the list of breakpoint locations.
1225 The new location does not have its condition field set to anything
1226 and therefore, we must always reparse the cond_string, independently
1227 of the value of the reparse flag. */
1228 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1229 {
1230 char *s = b->cond_string;
1231 b->loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1232 }
1233 }
1234 else if (!within_current_scope)
1235 {
1236 printf_filtered (_("\
1237 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1238 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1239 b->number);
1240 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1241 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1242 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1246 if (frame_saved)
1247 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1248 }
1249
1250
1251 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1252 inserted in the inferior. */
1253 static int
1254 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1255 {
1256 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1257 return 0;
1258
1259 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1260 return 0;
1261
1262 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1263 return 0;
1264
1265 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1266 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1267 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1268 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1269 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1270 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1271 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1272 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1273 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1274 return 0;
1275
1276 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1277 not by us. */
1278 if (bpt->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
1279 return 0;
1280
1281 return 1;
1282 }
1283
1284 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1285 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1286 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1287
1288 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1289 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1290 static int
1291 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1292 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1293 int *disabled_breaks,
1294 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1295 {
1296 int val = 0;
1297
1298 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1299 return 0;
1300
1301 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1302 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1303 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1304 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1305
1306 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1307 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1308 {
1309 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1310 {
1311 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1312 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1313 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1314 Two important cases are:
1315 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1316 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1317 hardware breakpoint.
1318 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1319 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1320 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1321
1322 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1323 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1324 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1325 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1326 struct mem_region *mr
1327 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1328
1329 if (mr)
1330 {
1331 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1332 {
1333 int changed = 0;
1334 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1335
1336 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1337 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1338 else
1339 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1340
1341 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1342 {
1343 static int said = 0;
1344 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1345 if (!said)
1346 {
1347 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1348 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1349 said = 1;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 }
1353 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1354 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1355 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1356 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1357 }
1358 }
1359
1360 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1361 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1362 || bpt->section == NULL
1363 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1364 {
1365 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1366
1367 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1368 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1369 &bpt->target_info);
1370 else
1371 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1372 &bpt->target_info);
1373 }
1374 else
1375 {
1376 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1377 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1378 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1379 {
1380 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1381 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1382 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1383 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1384 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1385 bpt->owner->number);
1386 else
1387 {
1388 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1389 bpt->section);
1390 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1391 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1392 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1393 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1394 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1395 if (val != 0)
1396 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1397 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1398 bpt->owner->number);
1399 }
1400 }
1401 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1402 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1403 {
1404 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1405 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1406 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1407 &bpt->target_info);
1408 else
1409 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1410 &bpt->target_info);
1411 }
1412 else
1413 {
1414 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1415 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1416 return 0;
1417 }
1418 }
1419
1420 if (val)
1421 {
1422 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1423 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1424 {
1425 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1426 val = 0;
1427 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1428 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1429 {
1430 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1431 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1432 bpt->owner->number);
1433 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1434 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1435 }
1436 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1437 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1438 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1439 }
1440 else
1441 {
1442 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1443 {
1444 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1445 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1446 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1447 bpt->owner->number);
1448 }
1449 else
1450 {
1451 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1452 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1453 bpt->owner->number);
1454 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1455 "Error accessing memory address ");
1456 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1457 tmp_error_stream);
1458 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1459 safe_strerror (val));
1460 }
1461
1462 }
1463 }
1464 else
1465 bpt->inserted = 1;
1466
1467 return val;
1468 }
1469
1470 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1471 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1472 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1473 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1474 {
1475 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1476 bpt->length,
1477 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1478 bpt->inserted = (val != -1);
1479 }
1480
1481 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1482 {
1483 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1484 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1485 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1486 bpt->owner->number);
1487 if (e.reason < 0)
1488 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1489 else
1490 bpt->inserted = 1;
1491
1492 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1493 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1494 so just return success. */
1495 return 0;
1496 }
1497
1498 return 0;
1499 }
1500
1501 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1502 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1503 PSPACE anymore. */
1504
1505 void
1506 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1507 {
1508 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1509 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1510
1511 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1512 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1513 {
1514 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1515 delete_breakpoint (b);
1516 }
1517
1518 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1519 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1520 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1521 {
1522 struct bp_location *tmp;
1523
1524 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1525 {
1526 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1527 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1528 else
1529 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1530 if (tmp->next == loc)
1531 {
1532 tmp->next = loc->next;
1533 break;
1534 }
1535 }
1536 }
1537
1538 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1539 removed locations above. */
1540 update_global_location_list (0);
1541 }
1542
1543 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1544 Throws exception on any error.
1545 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1546 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1547 void
1548 insert_breakpoints (void)
1549 {
1550 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1551
1552 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1553 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1554 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1555
1556 update_global_location_list (1);
1557
1558 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1559 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1560 now. */
1561 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1562 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1563 }
1564
1565 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1566 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1567 Both return zero if successful,
1568 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1569
1570 static void
1571 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1572 {
1573 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1574 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1575 int error = 0;
1576 int val = 0;
1577 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1578 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1579
1580 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1581 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1582
1583 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1584 there was an error. */
1585 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1586
1587 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1588
1589 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1590 {
1591 struct thread_info *tp;
1592 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1593
1594 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1595 continue;
1596
1597 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1598 thread no longer exists. */
1599 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1600 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1601 continue;
1602
1603 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1604
1605 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1606 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1607 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1608 insert breakpoints. */
1609 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1610 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1611 continue;
1612
1613 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1614 &disabled_breaks,
1615 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1616 if (val)
1617 error = val;
1618 }
1619
1620 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1621 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1622 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1623 {
1624 int some_failed = 0;
1625 struct bp_location *loc;
1626
1627 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1628 continue;
1629
1630 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1631 continue;
1632
1633 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1634 continue;
1635
1636 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1637 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1638 {
1639 some_failed = 1;
1640 break;
1641 }
1642 if (some_failed)
1643 {
1644 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1645 if (loc->inserted)
1646 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1647
1648 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1649 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1650 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1651 bpt->number);
1652 error = -1;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 if (error)
1657 {
1658 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1659 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1660 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1661 {
1662 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1663 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1664 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1665 }
1666 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1667 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1668 }
1669
1670 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1671 }
1672
1673 int
1674 remove_breakpoints (void)
1675 {
1676 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1677 int val = 0;
1678
1679 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1680 {
1681 if (b->inserted)
1682 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1683 }
1684 return val;
1685 }
1686
1687 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1688
1689 int
1690 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1691 {
1692 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1693 int val;
1694 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1695
1696 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1697 {
1698 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1699 continue;
1700
1701 if (b->inserted)
1702 {
1703 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1704 if (val != 0)
1705 return val;
1706 }
1707 }
1708 return 0;
1709 }
1710
1711 int
1712 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1713 {
1714 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1715 int val = 0;
1716
1717 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1718 {
1719 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1720 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1721 }
1722 return val;
1723 }
1724
1725 int
1726 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1727 {
1728 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1729 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1730 int val;
1731 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1732 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1733 struct inferior *inf;
1734 struct thread_info *tp;
1735
1736 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1737 if (tp == NULL)
1738 return 1;
1739
1740 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1741 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1742
1743 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1744
1745 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1746
1747 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1748 {
1749 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1750 continue;
1751
1752 if (b->inserted)
1753 {
1754 b->inserted = 0;
1755 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1756 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1757 if (val != 0)
1758 {
1759 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1760 return val;
1761 }
1762 }
1763 }
1764 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1765 return 0;
1766 }
1767
1768 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1769
1770 static struct breakpoint *
1771 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1772 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1773 {
1774 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1775 struct breakpoint *b;
1776
1777 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1778
1779 sal.pc = address;
1780 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1781 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1782
1783 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1784 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1785 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1786
1787 return b;
1788 }
1789
1790 static void
1791 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1792 {
1793 struct objfile *objfile;
1794
1795 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1796 {
1797 struct breakpoint *b;
1798 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1799
1800 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1801 if (m == NULL)
1802 continue;
1803
1804 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1805 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1806 bp_overlay_event);
1807 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1808
1809 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1810 {
1811 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1812 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1813 }
1814 else
1815 {
1816 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1817 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1818 }
1819 }
1820 update_global_location_list (1);
1821 }
1822
1823 static void
1824 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1825 {
1826 struct program_space *pspace;
1827 struct objfile *objfile;
1828 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1829
1830 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1831
1832 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1833 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1834 {
1835 struct breakpoint *b;
1836 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1837
1838 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1839 continue;
1840
1841 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1842
1843 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1844 if (m == NULL)
1845 continue;
1846
1847 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1848 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1849 bp_longjmp_master);
1850 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1851 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1852 }
1853 update_global_location_list (1);
1854
1855 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1856 }
1857
1858 void
1859 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1860 {
1861 struct breakpoint *b;
1862 struct breakpoint *temp;
1863 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1864
1865 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1866 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1867 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1868 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1869 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1870 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1871 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1872 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1873 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1874 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1875 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1876
1877 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1878 {
1879 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1880 continue;
1881
1882 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1883 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1884 {
1885 delete_breakpoint (b);
1886 continue;
1887 }
1888
1889 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1890 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1891 {
1892 delete_breakpoint (b);
1893 continue;
1894 }
1895
1896 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1897 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1898 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1899 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1900 {
1901 delete_breakpoint (b);
1902 continue;
1903 }
1904
1905 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
1906 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
1907 {
1908 delete_breakpoint (b);
1909 continue;
1910 }
1911
1912 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
1913 after an exec. */
1914 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
1915 {
1916 delete_breakpoint (b);
1917 continue;
1918 }
1919
1920 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
1921 {
1922 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
1923 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
1924 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
1925 a new method, and call this method from here. */
1926 continue;
1927 }
1928
1929 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
1930 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
1931 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
1932 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
1933 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
1934 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
1935
1936 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
1937 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
1938 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
1939 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
1940 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
1941 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
1942 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
1943
1944 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
1945 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
1946 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
1947 let finish_command delete it.
1948
1949 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
1950 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
1951 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
1952 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
1953 solib breakpoints.) */
1954
1955 if (b->type == bp_finish)
1956 {
1957 continue;
1958 }
1959
1960 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
1961 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
1962 a.out. */
1963 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
1964 {
1965 delete_breakpoint (b);
1966 continue;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
1970 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
1971 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
1972 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
1973 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
1974 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
1975 }
1976
1977 int
1978 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
1979 {
1980 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1981 int val = 0;
1982 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1983 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
1984
1985 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
1986 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
1987
1988 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
1989 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
1990 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1991 {
1992 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1993 continue;
1994
1995 if (b->inserted)
1996 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
1997 }
1998 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1999 return val;
2000 }
2001
2002 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2003 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2004 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2005 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2006 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2007
2008 static int
2009 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2010 {
2011 int val;
2012 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2013
2014 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2015 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2016 return 0;
2017
2018 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2019 This should not ever happen. */
2020 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2021
2022 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2023 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2024 {
2025 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2026 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2027 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2028
2029 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2030 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2031 || b->section == NULL
2032 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2033 {
2034 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2035
2036 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2037 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2038 else
2039 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2040 }
2041 else
2042 {
2043 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2044 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2045 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2046 {
2047 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2048 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2049 */
2050 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2051 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2052 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2053 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2054 &b->overlay_target_info);
2055 else
2056 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2057 &b->overlay_target_info);
2058 }
2059 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2060 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2061 if (b->inserted)
2062 {
2063 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2064 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2065 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2066 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2067 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2068 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2069 &b->target_info);
2070
2071 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2072 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2073 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2074 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2075 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2076 &b->target_info);
2077 else
2078 val = 0;
2079 }
2080 else
2081 {
2082 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2083 val = 0;
2084 }
2085 }
2086
2087 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2088 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2089 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2090 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2091 val = 0;
2092
2093 if (val)
2094 return val;
2095 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2096 }
2097 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2098 {
2099 struct value *v;
2100 struct value *n;
2101
2102 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2103 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2104 b->watchpoint_type);
2105
2106 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2107 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2108 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2109 b->owner->number);
2110 }
2111 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2112 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2113 && !b->duplicate)
2114 {
2115 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2116
2117 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2118 if (val)
2119 return val;
2120 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2121 }
2122
2123 return 0;
2124 }
2125
2126 static int
2127 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2128 {
2129 int ret;
2130 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2131
2132 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2133 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2134 return 0;
2135
2136 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2137 This should not ever happen. */
2138 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2139
2140 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2141
2142 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2143
2144 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2145
2146 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2147 return ret;
2148 }
2149
2150 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2151
2152 void
2153 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2154 {
2155 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2156
2157 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2158 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2159 bpt->inserted = 0;
2160 }
2161
2162 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2163 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2164
2165 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2166 between runs.
2167
2168 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2169 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2170 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2171
2172
2173
2174 void
2175 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2176 {
2177 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2178 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2179 int ix;
2180 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2181
2182 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2183 nothing to do. */
2184 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2185 return;
2186
2187 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2188 {
2189 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2190 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2191 bpt->inserted = 0;
2192 }
2193
2194 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2195 {
2196 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2197 continue;
2198
2199 switch (b->type)
2200 {
2201 case bp_call_dummy:
2202 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2203
2204 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2205 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better
2206 get rid of it.
2207
2208 Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2209 delete_breakpoint (b);
2210 break;
2211
2212 case bp_watchpoint:
2213 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2214 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2215 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2216
2217 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2218 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2219 delete_breakpoint (b);
2220 else if (context == inf_starting)
2221 {
2222 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2223 in insert_breakpoints. */
2224 if (b->val)
2225 value_free (b->val);
2226 b->val = NULL;
2227 b->val_valid = 0;
2228 }
2229 break;
2230 default:
2231 break;
2232 }
2233 }
2234
2235 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2236 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2237 free_bp_location (bpt);
2238 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2239 }
2240
2241 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2242 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2243 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2244 match, not program space. */
2245
2246 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2247 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2248 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2249 permanent breakpoint.
2250 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2251 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2252 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2253 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2254 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2255
2256 enum breakpoint_here
2257 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2258 {
2259 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2260 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2261
2262 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2263 {
2264 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2265 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2266 continue;
2267
2268 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2269 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2270 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2271 aspace, pc))
2272 {
2273 if (overlay_debugging
2274 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2275 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2276 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2277 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2278 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2279 else
2280 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2281 }
2282 }
2283
2284 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2285 }
2286
2287 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2288
2289 int
2290 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2291 {
2292 struct bp_location *loc;
2293 int ix;
2294
2295 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2296 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2297 aspace, pc))
2298 return 1;
2299
2300 return 0;
2301 }
2302
2303 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2304 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2305 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2306 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2307
2308 int
2309 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2310 {
2311 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2312
2313 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2314 {
2315 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2316 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2317 continue;
2318
2319 if (bpt->inserted
2320 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2321 aspace, pc))
2322 {
2323 if (overlay_debugging
2324 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2325 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2326 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2327 else
2328 return 1;
2329 }
2330 }
2331 return 0;
2332 }
2333
2334 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2335 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2336
2337 int
2338 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2339 {
2340 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2341 return 1;
2342
2343 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2344 return 1;
2345
2346 return 0;
2347 }
2348
2349 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2350 inserted at PC. */
2351
2352 int
2353 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2354 {
2355 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2356 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2357
2358 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2359 {
2360 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2361 continue;
2362
2363 if (bpt->inserted
2364 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2365 aspace, pc))
2366 {
2367 if (overlay_debugging
2368 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2369 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2370 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2371 else
2372 return 1;
2373 }
2374 }
2375
2376 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2377 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2378 return 1;
2379
2380 return 0;
2381 }
2382
2383 int
2384 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2385 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2386 {
2387 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2388
2389 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2390 {
2391 struct bp_location *loc;
2392
2393 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2394 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2395 continue;
2396
2397 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2398 continue;
2399
2400 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2401 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2402 {
2403 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2404
2405 /* Check for intersection. */
2406 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2407 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2408 if (l < h)
2409 return 1;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 return 0;
2413 }
2414
2415 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2416 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2417
2418 int
2419 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2420 ptid_t ptid)
2421 {
2422 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2423 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2424 int thread = -1;
2425 int task = 0;
2426
2427 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2428 {
2429 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2430 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2431 continue;
2432
2433 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2434 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2435 continue;
2436
2437 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2438 aspace, pc))
2439 continue;
2440
2441 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2442 {
2443 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2444 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2445 it is now time to do so. */
2446 if (thread == -1)
2447 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2448 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2449 continue;
2450 }
2451
2452 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2453 {
2454 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2455 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2456 it is now time to do so. */
2457 if (task == 0)
2458 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2459 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2460 continue;
2461 }
2462
2463 if (overlay_debugging
2464 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2465 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2466 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2467
2468 return 1;
2469 }
2470
2471 return 0;
2472 }
2473 \f
2474
2475 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2476 in breakpoint.h. */
2477
2478 int
2479 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2480 {
2481 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2482 }
2483
2484 void
2485 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2486 {
2487 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2488 value_free (bs->old_val);
2489 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2490 xfree (bs);
2491 }
2492
2493 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2494 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2495
2496 void
2497 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2498 {
2499 bpstat p;
2500 bpstat q;
2501
2502 if (bsp == 0)
2503 return;
2504 p = *bsp;
2505 while (p != NULL)
2506 {
2507 q = p->next;
2508 bpstat_free (p);
2509 p = q;
2510 }
2511 *bsp = NULL;
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2515 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2516
2517 bpstat
2518 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2519 {
2520 bpstat p = NULL;
2521 bpstat tmp;
2522 bpstat retval = NULL;
2523
2524 if (bs == NULL)
2525 return bs;
2526
2527 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2528 {
2529 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2530 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2531 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2532 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2533 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2534 {
2535 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2536 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2537 }
2538
2539 if (p == NULL)
2540 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2541 retval = tmp;
2542 else
2543 p->next = tmp;
2544 p = tmp;
2545 }
2546 p->next = NULL;
2547 return retval;
2548 }
2549
2550 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2551
2552 bpstat
2553 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2554 {
2555 if (bsp == NULL)
2556 return NULL;
2557
2558 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2559 {
2560 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2561 return bsp;
2562 }
2563 return NULL;
2564 }
2565
2566 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2567 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2568 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2569
2570 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2571 step_resume breakpoint.
2572
2573 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2574 struct breakpoint *
2575 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2576 {
2577 int current_thread;
2578
2579 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2580
2581 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2582
2583 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2584 {
2585 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2586 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2587 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2588 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2589 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2590 }
2591
2592 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2593 }
2594
2595
2596 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2597 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2598 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2599 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2600 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2601 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2602 we set it.
2603 Return 1 otherwise. */
2604
2605 int
2606 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2607 {
2608 struct breakpoint *b;
2609
2610 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2611 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2612
2613 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2614 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2615 this function might return the same number more
2616 than once and this will look ugly. */
2617 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2618 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2619 if (b == NULL)
2620 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2621
2622 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2623 return 1;
2624 }
2625
2626 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2627
2628 void
2629 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2630 {
2631 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2632 {
2633 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2634 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2635 {
2636 value_free (bs->old_val);
2637 bs->old_val = NULL;
2638 }
2639 }
2640 }
2641
2642 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2643
2644 static void
2645 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2646 {
2647 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2648 {
2649 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2650
2651 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2652 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2653 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2654 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2655 if (tp->in_infcall)
2656 return;
2657 }
2658
2659 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2660 }
2661
2662 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2663 static void
2664 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2665 {
2666 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2670 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2671 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2672 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2673
2674 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2675 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2676 bpstat of the current thread. */
2677
2678 static int
2679 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2680 {
2681 bpstat bs;
2682 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2683 int again = 0;
2684
2685 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2686 in bs->commands. */
2687 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2688 return 0;
2689
2690 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2691 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2692
2693 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2694 bs = *bsp;
2695
2696 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2697 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2698 {
2699 struct command_line *cmd;
2700 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2701
2702 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2703
2704 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2705 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2706 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2707 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2708 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2709 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2710 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2711 the tree when we're done. */
2712 cmd = bs->commands;
2713 bs->commands = 0;
2714 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2715
2716 while (cmd != NULL)
2717 {
2718 execute_control_command (cmd);
2719
2720 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2721 break;
2722 else
2723 cmd = cmd->next;
2724 }
2725
2726 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2727 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2728
2729 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2730 {
2731 if (target_can_async_p ())
2732 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2733 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2734 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2735 ;
2736 else
2737 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2738 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2739 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2740 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2741 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2742 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2743 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2744 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2745 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2746 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2747 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2748 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2749 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2750 again = 1;
2751 break;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2755 return again;
2756 }
2757
2758 void
2759 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2760 {
2761 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2762 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2763 && target_has_execution
2764 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2765 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2766 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2767 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2768 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2769 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2770 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2771 break;
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2775
2776 static void
2777 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2778 {
2779 if (val == NULL)
2780 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2781 else
2782 {
2783 struct value_print_options opts;
2784 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2785 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2786 }
2787 }
2788
2789 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2790 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2791 by having it set different print_it values.
2792
2793 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2794 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2795 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2796 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2797 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2798
2799 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2800 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2801 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2802 don't print anything else.
2803 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2804 that something to be followed by a location.
2805 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2806 that something to be followed by a location.
2807 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2808 analysis. */
2809
2810 static enum print_stop_action
2811 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2812 {
2813 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2814 struct breakpoint *b;
2815 const struct bp_location *bl;
2816 struct ui_stream *stb;
2817 int bp_temp = 0;
2818 enum print_stop_action result;
2819
2820 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2821 which has since been deleted. */
2822 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2823 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2824 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2825 b = bl->owner;
2826
2827 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2828 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2829
2830 switch (b->type)
2831 {
2832 case bp_breakpoint:
2833 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2834 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2835 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2836 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2837 bl->address,
2838 b->number, 1);
2839 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2840 if (bp_temp)
2841 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2842 else
2843 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2844 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2845 {
2846 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2847 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2848 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2849 }
2850 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2851 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2852 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2853 break;
2854
2855 case bp_shlib_event:
2856 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2857 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2858 to shlib event" message.) */
2859 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2860 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2861 break;
2862
2863 case bp_thread_event:
2864 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2865 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2866 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2867 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2868 break;
2869
2870 case bp_overlay_event:
2871 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2872 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2873 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2874 break;
2875
2876 case bp_longjmp_master:
2877 /* These should never be enabled. */
2878 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2879 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2880 break;
2881
2882 case bp_watchpoint:
2883 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2884 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2885 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2886 ui_out_field_string
2887 (uiout, "reason",
2888 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2889 mention (b);
2890 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2891 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2892 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2893 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2894 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2895 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2896 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2897 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2898 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
2899 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2900 break;
2901
2902 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2903 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2904 ui_out_field_string
2905 (uiout, "reason",
2906 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2907 mention (b);
2908 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2909 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2910 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2911 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
2912 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2913 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2914 break;
2915
2916 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2917 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2918 {
2919 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2920 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2921 ui_out_field_string
2922 (uiout, "reason",
2923 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2924 mention (b);
2925 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2926 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
2927 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
2928 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
2929 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
2930 }
2931 else
2932 {
2933 mention (b);
2934 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2935 ui_out_field_string
2936 (uiout, "reason",
2937 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
2938 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
2939 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
2940 }
2941 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
2942 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
2943 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
2944 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2945 break;
2946
2947 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
2948 here. */
2949
2950 case bp_finish:
2951 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2952 ui_out_field_string
2953 (uiout, "reason",
2954 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
2955 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2956 break;
2957
2958 case bp_until:
2959 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2960 ui_out_field_string
2961 (uiout, "reason",
2962 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
2963 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2964 break;
2965
2966 case bp_none:
2967 case bp_longjmp:
2968 case bp_longjmp_resume:
2969 case bp_step_resume:
2970 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2971 case bp_call_dummy:
2972 case bp_tracepoint:
2973 case bp_jit_event:
2974 default:
2975 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2976 break;
2977 }
2978
2979 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2980 return result;
2981 }
2982
2983 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
2984 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
2985 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
2986 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
2987 normal_stop(). */
2988
2989 static enum print_stop_action
2990 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
2991 {
2992 switch (bs->print_it)
2993 {
2994 case print_it_noop:
2995 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
2996 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2997 break;
2998
2999 case print_it_done:
3000 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3001 relevant messages. */
3002 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3003 break;
3004
3005 case print_it_normal:
3006 {
3007 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3008 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3009
3010 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3011 print_it_typical. */
3012 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3013 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3014 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3015 else
3016 return print_it_typical (bs);
3017 }
3018 break;
3019
3020 default:
3021 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3022 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3023 break;
3024 }
3025 }
3026
3027 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3028 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3029 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3030 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3031 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3032 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3033 routine is one of:
3034
3035 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3036 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3037 code to print the location. An example is
3038 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3039 the location.
3040 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3041 to also print the location part of the message.
3042 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3043 don't require a location appended to the end.
3044 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3045 further info to be printed.*/
3046
3047 enum print_stop_action
3048 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3049 {
3050 int val;
3051
3052 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3053 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3054 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3055 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3056 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3057 {
3058 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3059 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3060 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3061 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3062 return val;
3063 }
3064
3065 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3066 with and nothing was printed. */
3067 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3068 }
3069
3070 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3071 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3072 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3073 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3074
3075 static int
3076 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3077 {
3078 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3079 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3080 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3081 return i;
3082 }
3083
3084 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3085
3086 static bpstat
3087 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3088 {
3089 bpstat bs;
3090
3091 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3092 cbs->next = bs;
3093 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3094 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3095 bs->commands = NULL;
3096 bs->old_val = NULL;
3097 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3098 return bs;
3099 }
3100 \f
3101 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3102 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3103
3104 int
3105 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3106 {
3107 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3108 CORE_ADDR addr;
3109 struct breakpoint *b;
3110
3111 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3112 {
3113 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3114 as not triggered. */
3115 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3116 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3117 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3118 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3119 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3120
3121 return 0;
3122 }
3123
3124 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3125 {
3126 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3127 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3128 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3129 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3130 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3131 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3132 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3133
3134 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3135 }
3136
3137 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3138 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3139 triggered. */
3140
3141 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3142 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3143 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3144 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3145 {
3146 struct bp_location *loc;
3147 struct value *v;
3148
3149 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3150 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3151 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3152 sufficient. */
3153 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3154 addr, loc->address,
3155 loc->length))
3156 {
3157 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3158 break;
3159 }
3160 }
3161
3162 return 1;
3163 }
3164
3165 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3166 because of check_errors). */
3167 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3168 #define WP_DELETED 1
3169 /* The value has changed. */
3170 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3171 /* The value has not changed. */
3172 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3173
3174 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3175 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3176
3177 /* Check watchpoint condition. */
3178
3179 static int
3180 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3181 {
3182 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3183 struct breakpoint *b;
3184 struct frame_info *fr;
3185 int within_current_scope;
3186
3187 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3188
3189 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3190 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3191 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3192 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3193 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3194
3195 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3196 within_current_scope = 1;
3197 else
3198 {
3199 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3200 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3201 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3202
3203 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3204 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3205
3206 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3207 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3208 if (within_current_scope)
3209 {
3210 struct symbol *function;
3211
3212 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3213 if (function == NULL
3214 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3215 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3216 within_current_scope = 0;
3217 }
3218
3219 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3220 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3221 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3222 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3223 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3224 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3225 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3226 is likely to be wrong. */
3227 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3228 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3229
3230 if (within_current_scope)
3231 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3232 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3233 the user. */
3234 select_frame (fr);
3235 }
3236
3237 if (within_current_scope)
3238 {
3239 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3240 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3241 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3242 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3243
3244 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3245 struct value *new_val;
3246
3247 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3248 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3249 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal (b->val, new_val)))
3250 {
3251 if (new_val != NULL)
3252 {
3253 release_value (new_val);
3254 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3255 }
3256 bs->old_val = b->val;
3257 b->val = new_val;
3258 b->val_valid = 1;
3259 /* We will stop here */
3260 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3261 }
3262 else
3263 {
3264 /* Nothing changed, don't do anything. */
3265 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3266 /* We won't stop here */
3267 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3268 }
3269 }
3270 else
3271 {
3272 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3273 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3274 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3275 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3276 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3277 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3278 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3279 the first value assigned). */
3280 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3281 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3282 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3283 information here. */
3284 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3285 ui_out_field_string
3286 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3287 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3288 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3289 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3290 which its expression is valid.\n");
3291
3292 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3293 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3294 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3295
3296 return WP_DELETED;
3297 }
3298 }
3299
3300 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3301 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3302 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3303 static int
3304 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3305 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3306 {
3307 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3308
3309 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3310 tracepoints. */
3311 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
3312 return 0;
3313
3314 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3315 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3316 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3317 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3318 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3319 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3320 {
3321 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3322 aspace, bp_addr))
3323 return 0;
3324 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3325 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3326 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3327 return 0;
3328 }
3329
3330 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3331 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3332 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3333 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3334 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3335 (did not match the data address). */
3336
3337 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3338 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3339 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3340 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3341 return 0;
3342
3343 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3344 {
3345 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3346 return 0;
3347 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3348 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3349 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3350 return 0;
3351 }
3352
3353 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3354 {
3355 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3356 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3357 return 0;
3358 }
3359
3360 return 1;
3361 }
3362
3363 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3364 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3365 to 0. */
3366 static void
3367 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3368 {
3369 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3370 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3371
3372 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3373 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3374 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3375 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3376 {
3377 CORE_ADDR addr;
3378 struct value *v;
3379 int must_check_value = 0;
3380
3381 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3382 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3383 watched value. */
3384 must_check_value = 1;
3385 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3386 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3387 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3388 this watchpoint. */
3389 must_check_value = 1;
3390 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3391 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3392 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3393 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3394 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3395 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3396 must_check_value = 1;
3397
3398 if (must_check_value)
3399 {
3400 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3401 b->number);
3402 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3403 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3404 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3405 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3406 switch (e)
3407 {
3408 case WP_DELETED:
3409 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3410 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3411 /* Stop. */
3412 break;
3413 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3414 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3415 {
3416 /* Don't stop: read watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3417 the value has changed. This is for targets
3418 which cannot set read-only watchpoints. */
3419 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3420 bs->stop = 0;
3421 }
3422 break;
3423 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3424 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3425 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3426 {
3427 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3428 the value hasn't changed. */
3429 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3430 bs->stop = 0;
3431 }
3432 /* Stop. */
3433 break;
3434 default:
3435 /* Can't happen. */
3436 case 0:
3437 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3438 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3439 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3440 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3441 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3442 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3443 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3444 break;
3445 }
3446 }
3447 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3448 {
3449 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3450 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3451 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3452 anything for this watchpoint. */
3453 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3454 bs->stop = 0;
3455 }
3456 }
3457 }
3458
3459
3460 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3461 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3462 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3463 static void
3464 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3465 {
3466 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3467 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3468 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3469
3470 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3471 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3472 bs->stop = 0;
3473 else if (bs->stop)
3474 {
3475 int value_is_zero = 0;
3476
3477 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3478 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3479 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3480 iteration. */
3481 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3482 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3483
3484 if (bl->cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3485 {
3486 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3487 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3488 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3489 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3490 function call. */
3491 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3492
3493 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3494 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3495 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3496 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3497 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3498 call site. */
3499 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3500 value_is_zero
3501 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, (bl->cond),
3502 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3503 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3504 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3505 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3506 }
3507 if (bl->cond && value_is_zero)
3508 {
3509 bs->stop = 0;
3510 }
3511 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3512 {
3513 bs->stop = 0;
3514 }
3515 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3516 {
3517 b->ignore_count--;
3518 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3519 bs->stop = 0;
3520 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3521 stop. */
3522 ++(b->hit_count);
3523 }
3524 }
3525 }
3526
3527
3528 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3529 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3530
3531 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3532 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3533
3534 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3535
3536 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3537
3538 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3539 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3540 several reasons concurrently.)
3541
3542 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3543 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3544
3545 bpstat
3546 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3547 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3548 {
3549 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3550 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3551 struct bp_location *loc;
3552 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3553 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3554 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3555 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3556 int ix;
3557 int need_remove_insert, update_locations = 0;
3558
3559 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3560 {
3561 b = bl->owner;
3562 gdb_assert (b);
3563 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3564 continue;
3565 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3566 continue;
3567
3568 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3569 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3570 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3571 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3572 already. */
3573 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3574 continue;
3575
3576 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3577 continue;
3578
3579 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3580
3581 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3582
3583 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3584 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3585 'stop' to 0. */
3586 bs->stop = 1;
3587 bs->print = 1;
3588
3589 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3590 if (!bs->stop)
3591 continue;
3592
3593 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3594 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3595 /* We do not stop for these. */
3596 bs->stop = 0;
3597 else
3598 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3599
3600 if (bs->stop)
3601 {
3602 if (b->enable_state != bp_disabled)
3603 ++(b->hit_count);
3604
3605 /* We will stop here */
3606 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3607 {
3608 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3609 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3610 update_locations = 1;
3611 }
3612 if (b->silent)
3613 bs->print = 0;
3614 bs->commands = b->commands;
3615 if (bs->commands
3616 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3617 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q", bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3618 {
3619 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3620 bs->print = 0;
3621 }
3622 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3623 }
3624
3625 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or if we dont print. */
3626 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3627 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3628 }
3629
3630 /* Delay this call which would break the ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration above. */
3631 if (update_locations)
3632 update_global_location_list (0);
3633
3634 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3635 {
3636 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3637 aspace, bp_addr))
3638 {
3639 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3640 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3641 bs->stop = 0;
3642 bs->print = 0;
3643 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3644 }
3645 }
3646
3647 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3648 bs = root_bs->next; /* Re-grab the head of the chain */
3649
3650 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3651 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3652 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3653 done later. */
3654 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3655 if (bs->stop)
3656 break;
3657
3658 need_remove_insert = 0;
3659 if (bs == NULL)
3660 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3661 if (!bs->stop
3662 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3663 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3664 {
3665 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3666 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3667 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3668 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3669 need_remove_insert = 1;
3670 }
3671
3672 if (need_remove_insert)
3673 update_global_location_list (1);
3674
3675 return root_bs->next;
3676 }
3677 \f
3678 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3679 struct bpstat_what
3680 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3681 {
3682 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3683 enum class
3684 {
3685 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3686 no_effect = 0,
3687
3688 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3689 wp_silent,
3690
3691 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3692 wp_noisy,
3693
3694 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3695 bp_nostop,
3696
3697 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3698 bp_silent,
3699
3700 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3701 bp_noisy,
3702
3703 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3704 long_jump,
3705
3706 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3707 long_resume,
3708
3709 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3710 step_resume,
3711
3712 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3713 shlib_event,
3714
3715 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3716 jit_event,
3717
3718 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3719 class_last
3720 };
3721
3722 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3723 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3724 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3725 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3726 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3727 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3728 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3729 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3730 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3731 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3732 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3733 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3734
3735 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3736 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3737 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3738 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3739
3740 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3741 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3742 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3743 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3744 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3745 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3746 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3747
3748 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3749 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3750 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3751 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3752 ordering is:
3753
3754 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3755 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3756 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3757 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3758 ss < jit shl sn sr
3759 sn < jit shl sr
3760 jit < shl sr
3761 shl < sr
3762 sr <
3763
3764 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3765 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3766 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3767 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3768 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3769
3770 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
3771 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
3772 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
3773
3774 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
3775 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
3776 {
3777 /* old action */
3778 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
3779 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
3780 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3781 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3782 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
3783 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
3784 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
3785 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
3786 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
3787 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
3788 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
3789 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
3790 };
3791
3792 #undef kc
3793 #undef ss
3794 #undef sn
3795 #undef sgl
3796 #undef slr
3797 #undef clr
3798 #undef err
3799 #undef sr
3800 #undef ts
3801 #undef shl
3802 #undef jit
3803 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
3804 struct bpstat_what retval;
3805
3806 retval.call_dummy = 0;
3807 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3808 {
3809 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
3810 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3811 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
3812 which has since been deleted. */
3813 continue;
3814 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
3815 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3816 else
3817 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
3818 {
3819 case bp_none:
3820 continue;
3821
3822 case bp_breakpoint:
3823 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3824 case bp_until:
3825 case bp_finish:
3826 if (bs->stop)
3827 {
3828 if (bs->print)
3829 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3830 else
3831 bs_class = bp_silent;
3832 }
3833 else
3834 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3835 break;
3836 case bp_watchpoint:
3837 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3838 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3839 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3840 if (bs->stop)
3841 {
3842 if (bs->print)
3843 bs_class = wp_noisy;
3844 else
3845 bs_class = wp_silent;
3846 }
3847 else
3848 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3849 This requires no further action. */
3850 bs_class = no_effect;
3851 break;
3852 case bp_longjmp:
3853 bs_class = long_jump;
3854 break;
3855 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3856 bs_class = long_resume;
3857 break;
3858 case bp_step_resume:
3859 if (bs->stop)
3860 {
3861 bs_class = step_resume;
3862 }
3863 else
3864 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
3865 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3866 break;
3867 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3868 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3869 break;
3870 case bp_shlib_event:
3871 bs_class = shlib_event;
3872 break;
3873 case bp_jit_event:
3874 bs_class = jit_event;
3875 break;
3876 case bp_thread_event:
3877 case bp_overlay_event:
3878 case bp_longjmp_master:
3879 bs_class = bp_nostop;
3880 break;
3881 case bp_catchpoint:
3882 if (bs->stop)
3883 {
3884 if (bs->print)
3885 bs_class = bp_noisy;
3886 else
3887 bs_class = bp_silent;
3888 }
3889 else
3890 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
3891 This requires no further action. */
3892 bs_class = no_effect;
3893 break;
3894 case bp_call_dummy:
3895 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
3896 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
3897 bs_class = bp_silent;
3898 retval.call_dummy = 1;
3899 break;
3900 case bp_tracepoint:
3901 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
3902 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
3903 out already. */
3904 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3905 _("bpstat_what: bp_tracepoint encountered"));
3906 break;
3907 }
3908 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
3909 }
3910 retval.main_action = current_action;
3911 return retval;
3912 }
3913
3914 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
3915 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
3916 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
3917
3918 int
3919 bpstat_should_step (void)
3920 {
3921 struct breakpoint *b;
3922 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3923 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
3924 return 1;
3925 return 0;
3926 }
3927
3928 int
3929 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
3930 {
3931 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3932 if (bs->stop)
3933 return 1;
3934
3935 return 0;
3936 }
3937
3938 \f
3939
3940 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
3941
3942 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3943 struct bp_location *loc,
3944 char *wrap_indent,
3945 struct ui_stream *stb)
3946 {
3947 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3948
3949 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
3950 loc = NULL;
3951
3952 if (loc != NULL)
3953 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
3954
3955 if (b->source_file && loc)
3956 {
3957 struct symbol *sym
3958 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
3959 if (sym)
3960 {
3961 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
3962 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
3963 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
3964 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
3965 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
3966 }
3967 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
3968 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
3969
3970 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3971 {
3972 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
3973 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
3974
3975 if (fullname)
3976 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
3977 }
3978
3979 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
3980 }
3981 else if (loc)
3982 {
3983 print_address_symbolic (loc->address, stb->stream, demangle, "");
3984 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
3985 }
3986 else
3987 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
3988
3989 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3990 }
3991
3992 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
3993 static void
3994 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
3995 struct bp_location *loc,
3996 int loc_number,
3997 struct bp_location **last_loc,
3998 int print_address_bits,
3999 int allflag)
4000 {
4001 struct command_line *l;
4002 struct symbol *sym;
4003 struct ep_type_description
4004 {
4005 enum bptype type;
4006 char *description;
4007 };
4008 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4009 {
4010 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4011 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4012 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4013 {bp_until, "until"},
4014 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4015 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4016 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4017 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4018 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4019 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4020 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4021 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4022 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4023 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4024 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4025 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4026 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4027 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4028 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4029 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4030 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4031 };
4032
4033 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4034 char wrap_indent[80];
4035 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4036 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4037 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4038
4039 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4040 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4041 struct value_print_options opts;
4042
4043 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4044
4045 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4046 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4047 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4048 location. */
4049 if (loc == NULL
4050 && (b->loc != NULL
4051 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4052 header_of_multiple = 1;
4053 if (loc == NULL)
4054 loc = b->loc;
4055
4056 annotate_record ();
4057 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4058
4059 /* 1 */
4060 annotate_field (0);
4061 if (part_of_multiple)
4062 {
4063 char *formatted;
4064 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4065 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4066 xfree (formatted);
4067 }
4068 else
4069 {
4070 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4071 }
4072
4073 /* 2 */
4074 annotate_field (1);
4075 if (part_of_multiple)
4076 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4077 else
4078 {
4079 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4080 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4081 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4082 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4083 (int) b->type);
4084 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4085 }
4086
4087 /* 3 */
4088 annotate_field (2);
4089 if (part_of_multiple)
4090 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4091 else
4092 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4093
4094
4095 /* 4 */
4096 annotate_field (3);
4097 if (part_of_multiple)
4098 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4099 else
4100 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4101 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4102 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4103
4104
4105 /* 5 and 6 */
4106 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4107 if (opts.addressprint)
4108 {
4109 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4110 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4111 else
4112 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4113 }
4114
4115 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4116 {
4117 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4118 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4119 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4120 just one location. */
4121 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4122 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4123 }
4124 else
4125 switch (b->type)
4126 {
4127 case bp_none:
4128 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4129 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4130 break;
4131
4132 case bp_watchpoint:
4133 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4134 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4135 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4136 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4137 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4138 is relatively readable). */
4139 if (opts.addressprint)
4140 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4141 annotate_field (5);
4142 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4143 break;
4144
4145 case bp_breakpoint:
4146 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4147 case bp_until:
4148 case bp_finish:
4149 case bp_longjmp:
4150 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4151 case bp_step_resume:
4152 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4153 case bp_call_dummy:
4154 case bp_shlib_event:
4155 case bp_thread_event:
4156 case bp_overlay_event:
4157 case bp_longjmp_master:
4158 case bp_tracepoint:
4159 case bp_jit_event:
4160 if (opts.addressprint)
4161 {
4162 annotate_field (4);
4163 if (header_of_multiple)
4164 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4165 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4166 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4167 else
4168 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4169 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4170 }
4171 annotate_field (5);
4172 if (!header_of_multiple)
4173 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4174 if (b->loc)
4175 *last_loc = b->loc;
4176 break;
4177 }
4178
4179
4180 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4181 are several. */
4182 if (loc != NULL
4183 && !header_of_multiple
4184 && (allflag
4185 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4186 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4187 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4188 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4189 {
4190 struct inferior *inf;
4191 int first = 1;
4192
4193 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4194 {
4195 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4196 {
4197 if (first)
4198 {
4199 first = 0;
4200 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4201 }
4202 else
4203 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4204 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4205 }
4206 }
4207 }
4208
4209 if (!part_of_multiple)
4210 {
4211 if (b->thread != -1)
4212 {
4213 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4214 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4215 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4216 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4217 }
4218 else if (b->task != 0)
4219 {
4220 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4221 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4222 }
4223 }
4224
4225 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4226
4227 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4228 {
4229 annotate_field (6);
4230 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4231 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4232 the frame ID. */
4233 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4234 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4235 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4236 }
4237
4238 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4239 {
4240 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4241 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4242 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4243 annotate_field (7);
4244 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint)
4245 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4246 else
4247 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4248 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4249 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4250 }
4251
4252 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4253 {
4254 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4255 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4256 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4257 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4258 }
4259
4260 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4261 {
4262 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4263 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4264 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4265 else
4266 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4267 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4268 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4269 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4270 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4271 else
4272 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4273 }
4274
4275 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4276 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4277 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4278 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4279 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4280
4281 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4282 {
4283 annotate_field (8);
4284 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4285 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4286 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4287 }
4288
4289 l = b->commands;
4290 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4291 {
4292 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4293
4294 annotate_field (9);
4295 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4296 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4297 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4298 }
4299
4300 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4301 {
4302 annotate_field (10);
4303 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4304 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4305 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4306 }
4307
4308 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4309 {
4310 annotate_field (11);
4311 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4312 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4313 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4314 }
4315
4316 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4317 {
4318 struct action_line *action;
4319 annotate_field (12);
4320 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4321 {
4322 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4323 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4324 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4325 }
4326 }
4327
4328 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4329 {
4330 if (b->addr_string)
4331 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4332 else if (b->exp_string)
4333 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4334 }
4335
4336 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4337 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4338 }
4339
4340 static void
4341 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4342 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4343 int allflag)
4344 {
4345 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4346 print_address_bits, allflag);
4347
4348 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4349 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4350 locations, if any. */
4351 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4352 {
4353 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4354 disabled, we print it as if it had
4355 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4356 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4357 situation.
4358 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4359 several locations internally, that's no a property
4360 exposed to user. */
4361 if (b->loc
4362 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4363 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4364 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4365 {
4366 struct bp_location *loc;
4367 int n = 1;
4368 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4369 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4370 print_address_bits, allflag);
4371 }
4372 }
4373 }
4374
4375 static int
4376 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4377 {
4378 int print_address_bits = 0;
4379 struct bp_location *loc;
4380
4381 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4382 {
4383 int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4384 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4385 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4386 }
4387
4388 return print_address_bits;
4389 }
4390
4391 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4392 {
4393 int bnum;
4394 };
4395
4396 static int
4397 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4398 {
4399 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4400 struct breakpoint *b;
4401 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4402 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4403 {
4404 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4405 {
4406 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4407 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4408 return GDB_RC_OK;
4409 }
4410 }
4411 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4412 }
4413
4414 enum gdb_rc
4415 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4416 {
4417 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4418 args.bnum = bnum;
4419 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4420 an error. */
4421 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4422 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4423 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4424 else
4425 return GDB_RC_OK;
4426 }
4427
4428 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4429 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4430
4431 static int
4432 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4433 {
4434 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4435 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4436 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4437 || b->type == bp_tracepoint
4438 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4439 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4440 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4441 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4442 }
4443
4444 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4445 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4446 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4447
4448 static void
4449 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4450 {
4451 struct breakpoint *b;
4452 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4453 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4454 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4455 struct value_print_options opts;
4456 int print_address_bits = 0;
4457
4458 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4459
4460 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4461 size required for address fields. */
4462 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4463 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4464 if (bnum == -1
4465 || bnum == b->number)
4466 {
4467 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4468 {
4469 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4470 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4471 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4472
4473 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4474 }
4475 }
4476
4477 if (opts.addressprint)
4478 bkpttbl_chain
4479 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4480 "BreakpointTable");
4481 else
4482 bkpttbl_chain
4483 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4484 "BreakpointTable");
4485
4486 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4487 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4488 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4489 annotate_field (0);
4490 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4491 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4492 annotate_field (1);
4493 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4494 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4495 annotate_field (2);
4496 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4497 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4498 annotate_field (3);
4499 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4500 if (opts.addressprint)
4501 {
4502 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4503 annotate_field (4);
4504 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4505 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4506 else
4507 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4508 }
4509 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4510 annotate_field (5);
4511 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4512 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4513 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4514 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4515
4516 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4517 if (bnum == -1
4518 || bnum == b->number)
4519 {
4520 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4521 allflag is set. */
4522 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4523 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4524 }
4525
4526 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4527
4528 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4529 {
4530 if (bnum == -1)
4531 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4532 else
4533 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4534 bnum);
4535 }
4536 else
4537 {
4538 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4539 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4540 }
4541
4542 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4543 there have been breakpoints? */
4544 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4545 }
4546
4547 static void
4548 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4549 {
4550 int bnum = -1;
4551
4552 if (bnum_exp)
4553 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4554
4555 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4556 }
4557
4558 static void
4559 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4560 {
4561 int bnum = -1;
4562
4563 if (bnum_exp)
4564 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4565
4566 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4567 }
4568
4569 static int
4570 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4571 struct program_space *pspace,
4572 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4573 {
4574 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4575 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4576 {
4577 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4578 && bl->address == pc
4579 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4580 return 1;
4581 }
4582 return 0;
4583 }
4584
4585 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4586 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4587 address spaces. */
4588
4589 static void
4590 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4591 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4592 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4593 {
4594 int others = 0;
4595 struct breakpoint *b;
4596
4597 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4598 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4599 if (others > 0)
4600 {
4601 if (others == 1)
4602 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4603 else /* if (others == ???) */
4604 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4605 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4606 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4607 {
4608 others--;
4609 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4610 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4611 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4612 else if (b->thread != -1)
4613 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4614 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4615 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4616 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4617 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4618 ? " (disabled)"
4619 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4620 ? " (permanent)"
4621 : ""),
4622 (others > 1) ? ","
4623 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4624 }
4625 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4626 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4627 printf_filtered (".\n");
4628 }
4629 }
4630 \f
4631 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4632 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4633
4634 void
4635 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4636 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4637 int line)
4638 {
4639 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4640 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4641 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4642 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4643 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4644 }
4645
4646 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4647 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4648 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4649 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4650
4651 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4652 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4653 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4654
4655 bp_watchpoint
4656 bp_catchpoint
4657
4658 */
4659
4660 static int
4661 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4662 {
4663 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4664
4665 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4666 }
4667
4668 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4669 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4670
4671 static int
4672 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4673 {
4674 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4675 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4676 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4677 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4678 }
4679
4680 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4681 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4682 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4683 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4684
4685 static int
4686 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4687 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4688 {
4689 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4690 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4691 && addr1 == addr2);
4692 }
4693
4694 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4695 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4696 represent the same location. */
4697
4698 static int
4699 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4700 {
4701 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4702 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4703
4704 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4705 return 0;
4706 else if (hw_point1)
4707 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4708 else
4709 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4710 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4711 }
4712
4713 static void
4714 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4715 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4716 {
4717 char astr1[40];
4718 char astr2[40];
4719
4720 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4721 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4722 if (have_bnum)
4723 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4724 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4725 else
4726 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4727 }
4728
4729 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4730 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4731 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4732 this function is simply the identity function. */
4733
4734 static CORE_ADDR
4735 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4736 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4737 {
4738 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4739 {
4740 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4741 return bpaddr;
4742 }
4743 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4744 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4745 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4746 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4747 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4748 {
4749 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
4750 have their addresses modified. */
4751 return bpaddr;
4752 }
4753 else
4754 {
4755 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
4756
4757 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
4758 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
4759 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
4760
4761 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
4762 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
4763 is required. */
4764 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
4765 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
4766
4767 return adjusted_bpaddr;
4768 }
4769 }
4770
4771 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
4772
4773 static struct bp_location *
4774 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4775 {
4776 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
4777
4778 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
4779 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
4780
4781 loc->owner = bpt;
4782 loc->cond = NULL;
4783 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
4784 loc->enabled = 1;
4785
4786 switch (bpt->type)
4787 {
4788 case bp_breakpoint:
4789 case bp_tracepoint:
4790 case bp_until:
4791 case bp_finish:
4792 case bp_longjmp:
4793 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4794 case bp_step_resume:
4795 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4796 case bp_call_dummy:
4797 case bp_shlib_event:
4798 case bp_thread_event:
4799 case bp_overlay_event:
4800 case bp_jit_event:
4801 case bp_longjmp_master:
4802 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
4803 break;
4804 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4805 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
4806 break;
4807 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4808 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4809 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4810 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
4811 break;
4812 case bp_watchpoint:
4813 case bp_catchpoint:
4814 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
4815 break;
4816 default:
4817 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
4818 }
4819
4820 return loc;
4821 }
4822
4823 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
4824 {
4825 if (loc->cond)
4826 xfree (loc->cond);
4827
4828 if (loc->function_name)
4829 xfree (loc->function_name);
4830
4831 xfree (loc);
4832 }
4833
4834 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
4835 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
4836 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
4837
4838 static struct breakpoint *
4839 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4840 enum bptype bptype)
4841 {
4842 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
4843
4844 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
4845 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
4846
4847 b->type = bptype;
4848 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
4849 b->language = current_language->la_language;
4850 b->input_radix = input_radix;
4851 b->thread = -1;
4852 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
4853 b->next = 0;
4854 b->silent = 0;
4855 b->ignore_count = 0;
4856 b->commands = NULL;
4857 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
4858 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
4859 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
4860 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
4861 b->ops = NULL;
4862 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
4863
4864 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
4865 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
4866 of increasing numbers. */
4867
4868 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
4869 if (b1 == 0)
4870 breakpoint_chain = b;
4871 else
4872 {
4873 while (b1->next)
4874 b1 = b1->next;
4875 b1->next = b;
4876 }
4877 return b;
4878 }
4879
4880 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
4881 static void
4882 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
4883 {
4884 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
4885 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4886 || loc->owner->type == bp_tracepoint)
4887 {
4888 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
4889 NULL, NULL);
4890 if (loc->function_name)
4891 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
4892 }
4893 }
4894
4895 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
4896 static struct gdbarch *
4897 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
4898 {
4899 if (sal.section)
4900 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
4901 if (sal.symtab)
4902 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
4903
4904 return NULL;
4905 }
4906
4907 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
4908 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
4909 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
4910 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
4911 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
4912 is also returned as the value of this function.
4913
4914 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
4915 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
4916 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
4917 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
4918 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
4919 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
4920 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
4921
4922 struct breakpoint *
4923 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4924 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
4925 {
4926 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
4927 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
4928 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
4929
4930 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
4931 if (!loc_gdbarch)
4932 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
4933
4934 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
4935 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
4936
4937 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
4938 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
4939 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
4940 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
4941 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
4942 location that's only been partially initialized. */
4943 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
4944
4945 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
4946 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
4947 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
4948 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
4949 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
4950
4951 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
4952 breakpoint resetting. */
4953 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
4954
4955 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
4956 b->source_file = NULL;
4957 else
4958 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
4959 b->loc->section = sal.section;
4960 b->line_number = sal.line;
4961
4962 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
4963
4964 breakpoints_changed ();
4965
4966 return b;
4967 }
4968
4969
4970 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
4971 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
4972 void
4973 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
4974 {
4975 struct bp_location *bl;
4976 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
4977
4978 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
4979 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
4980 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
4981 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
4982 but it's easy to implmement. */
4983 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
4984 bl->inserted = 1;
4985 }
4986
4987 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
4988 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
4989 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
4990
4991 void
4992 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
4993 {
4994 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
4995
4996 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
4997 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
4998 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
4999 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5000 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5001 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5002 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5003 {
5004 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5005 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5006 clone->thread = thread;
5007 }
5008 }
5009
5010 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5011 void
5012 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5013 {
5014 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5015
5016 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5017 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5018 {
5019 if (b->thread == thread)
5020 delete_breakpoint (b);
5021 }
5022 }
5023
5024 void
5025 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5026 {
5027 struct breakpoint *b;
5028
5029 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5030 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5031 {
5032 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5033 update_global_location_list (1);
5034 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5035 }
5036 }
5037
5038 void
5039 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5040 {
5041 struct breakpoint *b;
5042
5043 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5044 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5045 {
5046 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5047 update_global_location_list (0);
5048 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5049 }
5050 }
5051
5052 struct breakpoint *
5053 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5054 {
5055 struct breakpoint *b;
5056
5057 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5058
5059 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5060 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5061 b->addr_string
5062 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5063
5064 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5065
5066 return b;
5067 }
5068
5069 void
5070 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5071 {
5072 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5073
5074 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5075 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5076 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5077 delete_breakpoint (b);
5078 }
5079
5080 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5081 {
5082 char **arg_p;
5083 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5084 char ***addr_string_p;
5085 int *not_found_ptr;
5086 };
5087
5088 struct lang_and_radix
5089 {
5090 enum language lang;
5091 int radix;
5092 };
5093
5094 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5095
5096 struct breakpoint *
5097 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5098 {
5099 struct breakpoint *b;
5100
5101 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5102 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5103 return b;
5104 }
5105
5106 void
5107 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5108 {
5109 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5110
5111 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5112 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5113 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5114 delete_breakpoint (b);
5115 }
5116
5117 struct breakpoint *
5118 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5119 {
5120 struct breakpoint *b;
5121
5122 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5123 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5124 return b;
5125 }
5126
5127 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5128 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5129
5130 void
5131 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5132 {
5133 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5134
5135 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5136 {
5137 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5138 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5139 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5140 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5141 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5142 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5143 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5144 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5145 || (b->type == bp_tracepoint))
5146 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5147 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5148 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5149 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5150 #else
5151 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5152 #endif
5153 )
5154 {
5155 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5156 }
5157 }
5158 }
5159
5160 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5161 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5162
5163 static void
5164 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5165 {
5166 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5167 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5168
5169 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5170 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5171 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5172 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5173 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5174 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5175 return;
5176
5177 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5178 {
5179 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5180 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5181 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5182 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5183 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5184 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5185 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5186 {
5187 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5188 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5189 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5190 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5191 loc->inserted = 0;
5192 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5193 {
5194 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5195 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5196 solib->so_name);
5197 }
5198 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5199 }
5200 }
5201 }
5202
5203 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5204
5205 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5206
5207 static void
5208 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5209 {
5210 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5211 }
5212
5213 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5214
5215 static int
5216 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5217 {
5218 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5219 }
5220
5221 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5222 catchpoints. */
5223
5224 static int
5225 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5226 {
5227 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5228 }
5229
5230 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5231
5232 static enum print_stop_action
5233 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5234 {
5235 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5236 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5237 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5238 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5239 }
5240
5241 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5242
5243 static void
5244 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5245 {
5246 struct value_print_options opts;
5247
5248 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5249
5250 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5251 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5252 is relatively readable). */
5253 if (opts.addressprint)
5254 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5255 annotate_field (5);
5256 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5257 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5258 {
5259 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5260 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5261 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5262 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5263 }
5264 }
5265
5266 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5267 catchpoints. */
5268
5269 static void
5270 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5271 {
5272 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5273 }
5274
5275 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5276
5277 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5278 {
5279 insert_catch_fork,
5280 remove_catch_fork,
5281 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5282 print_it_catch_fork,
5283 print_one_catch_fork,
5284 print_mention_catch_fork
5285 };
5286
5287 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5288
5289 static void
5290 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5291 {
5292 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5293 }
5294
5295 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5296
5297 static int
5298 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5299 {
5300 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5301 }
5302
5303 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5304 catchpoints. */
5305
5306 static int
5307 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5308 {
5309 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5310 }
5311
5312 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5313
5314 static enum print_stop_action
5315 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5316 {
5317 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5318 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5319 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5320 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5321 }
5322
5323 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5324
5325 static void
5326 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5327 {
5328 struct value_print_options opts;
5329
5330 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5331 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5332 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5333 is relatively readable). */
5334 if (opts.addressprint)
5335 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5336 annotate_field (5);
5337 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5338 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5339 {
5340 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5341 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5342 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5343 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5344 }
5345 }
5346
5347 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5348 catchpoints. */
5349
5350 static void
5351 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5352 {
5353 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5354 }
5355
5356 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5357
5358 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5359 {
5360 insert_catch_vfork,
5361 remove_catch_vfork,
5362 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5363 print_it_catch_vfork,
5364 print_one_catch_vfork,
5365 print_mention_catch_vfork
5366 };
5367
5368 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5369 catchpoints. */
5370
5371 static void
5372 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5373 {
5374 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5375
5376 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5377 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5378 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5379 else
5380 {
5381 int i, iter;
5382 for (i = 0;
5383 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5384 i++)
5385 {
5386 int elem;
5387 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5388 {
5389 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5390 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5391 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5392 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5393 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5394 vec_addr_offset;
5395 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5396 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5397 }
5398 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5399 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5400 }
5401 }
5402
5403 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5404 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5405 inf->any_syscall_count,
5406 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5407 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5408 }
5409
5410 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5411 catchpoints. */
5412
5413 static int
5414 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5415 {
5416 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5417
5418 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5419 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5420 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5421 else
5422 {
5423 int i, iter;
5424 for (i = 0;
5425 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5426 i++)
5427 {
5428 int elem;
5429 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5430 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5431 continue;
5432 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5433 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5434 }
5435 }
5436
5437 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5438 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5439 inf->any_syscall_count,
5440 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5441 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5442 }
5443
5444 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5445 catchpoints. */
5446
5447 static int
5448 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5449 {
5450 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5451 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5452 syscall we are catching. */
5453 int syscall_number = 0;
5454
5455 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5456 return 0;
5457
5458 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5459 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5460 {
5461 int i, iter;
5462 for (i = 0;
5463 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5464 i++)
5465 if (syscall_number == iter)
5466 break;
5467 /* Not the same. */
5468 if (!iter)
5469 return 0;
5470 }
5471
5472 return 1;
5473 }
5474
5475 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5476 catchpoints. */
5477
5478 static enum print_stop_action
5479 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5480 {
5481 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5482 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5483 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5484 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5485 ptid_t ptid;
5486 struct target_waitstatus last;
5487 struct syscall s;
5488 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5489 char *syscall_id;
5490
5491 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5492
5493 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5494
5495 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5496
5497 if (s.name == NULL)
5498 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5499 else
5500 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5501
5502 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5503
5504 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5505 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5506 b->number, syscall_id);
5507 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5508 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5509 b->number, syscall_id);
5510
5511 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5512
5513 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5514 }
5515
5516 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5517 catchpoints. */
5518
5519 static void
5520 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5521 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5522 {
5523 struct value_print_options opts;
5524
5525 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5526 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5527 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5528 is relatively readable). */
5529 if (opts.addressprint)
5530 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5531 annotate_field (5);
5532
5533 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5534 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5535 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5536 else
5537 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5538
5539 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5540 {
5541 int i, iter;
5542 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5543 for (i = 0;
5544 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5545 i++)
5546 {
5547 char *x = text;
5548 struct syscall s;
5549 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5550
5551 if (s.name != NULL)
5552 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5553 else
5554 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5555
5556 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5557 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5558 on every call. */
5559 xfree (x);
5560 }
5561 /* Remove the last comma. */
5562 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5563 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5564 }
5565 else
5566 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5567 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5568 }
5569
5570 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5571 catchpoints. */
5572
5573 static void
5574 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5575 {
5576 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5577 {
5578 int i, iter;
5579
5580 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5581 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5582 else
5583 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5584
5585 for (i = 0;
5586 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5587 i++)
5588 {
5589 struct syscall s;
5590 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5591
5592 if (s.name)
5593 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5594 else
5595 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5596 }
5597 printf_filtered (")");
5598 }
5599 else
5600 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5601 b->number);
5602 }
5603
5604 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5605
5606 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5607 {
5608 insert_catch_syscall,
5609 remove_catch_syscall,
5610 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5611 print_it_catch_syscall,
5612 print_one_catch_syscall,
5613 print_mention_catch_syscall
5614 };
5615
5616 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5617
5618 static int
5619 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5620 {
5621 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5622 }
5623
5624 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5625 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5626 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5627 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5628
5629 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5630 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5631 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5632 to the catchpoint. */
5633
5634 static struct breakpoint *
5635 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5636 char *cond_string,
5637 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5638 {
5639 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5640 struct breakpoint *b;
5641
5642 init_sal (&sal);
5643 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5644
5645 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5646 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5647 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5648
5649 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5650 b->thread = -1;
5651 b->addr_string = NULL;
5652 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5653 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5654 b->ops = ops;
5655
5656 return b;
5657 }
5658
5659 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5660
5661 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5662 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5663 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5664 to the catchpoint. */
5665
5666 static struct breakpoint *
5667 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5668 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5669 {
5670 struct breakpoint *b =
5671 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5672
5673 mention (b);
5674 update_global_location_list (1);
5675
5676 return b;
5677 }
5678
5679 static void
5680 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5681 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5682 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5683 {
5684 struct breakpoint *b
5685 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5686
5687 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5688 area. */
5689 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5690 }
5691
5692 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5693
5694 static void
5695 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5696 {
5697 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5698 }
5699
5700 static int
5701 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5702 {
5703 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5704 }
5705
5706 static int
5707 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5708 {
5709 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5710 }
5711
5712 static enum print_stop_action
5713 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5714 {
5715 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5716 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5717 b->exec_pathname);
5718 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5719 }
5720
5721 static void
5722 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5723 {
5724 struct value_print_options opts;
5725
5726 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5727
5728 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5729 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5730 is relatively readable). */
5731 if (opts.addressprint)
5732 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5733 annotate_field (5);
5734 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5735 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5736 {
5737 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5738 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5739 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5740 }
5741 }
5742
5743 static void
5744 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5745 {
5746 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5747 }
5748
5749 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
5750 {
5751 insert_catch_exec,
5752 remove_catch_exec,
5753 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
5754 print_it_catch_exec,
5755 print_one_catch_exec,
5756 print_mention_catch_exec
5757 };
5758
5759 static void
5760 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
5761 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5762 {
5763 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
5764 struct breakpoint *b =
5765 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
5766
5767 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
5768
5769 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
5770 location list. */
5771 mention (b);
5772 update_global_location_list (1);
5773 }
5774
5775 static int
5776 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
5777 {
5778 struct breakpoint *b;
5779 int i = 0;
5780
5781 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5782 {
5783 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5784 i++;
5785 }
5786
5787 return i;
5788 }
5789
5790 static int
5791 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
5792 {
5793 struct breakpoint *b;
5794 int i = 0;
5795
5796 *other_type_used = 0;
5797 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5798 {
5799 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
5800 {
5801 if (b->type == type)
5802 i++;
5803 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5804 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
5805 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5806 *other_type_used = 1;
5807 }
5808 }
5809 return i;
5810 }
5811
5812 void
5813 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
5814 {
5815 struct breakpoint *b;
5816
5817 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5818 {
5819 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5820 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5821 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5822 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5823 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5824 {
5825 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
5826 update_global_location_list (0);
5827 }
5828 }
5829 }
5830
5831 void
5832 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
5833 {
5834 struct breakpoint *b;
5835
5836 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5837 {
5838 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5839 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5840 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5841 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
5842 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
5843 {
5844 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5845 update_global_location_list (1);
5846 }
5847 }
5848 }
5849
5850 void
5851 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
5852 {
5853 struct breakpoint *b;
5854 int found = 0;
5855
5856 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5857 {
5858 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5859 continue;
5860
5861 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5862 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5863 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
5864 {
5865 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
5866 found = 1;
5867 }
5868 }
5869
5870 if (found)
5871 update_global_location_list (0);
5872
5873 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
5874 }
5875
5876 void
5877 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
5878 {
5879 struct breakpoint *b;
5880 int found = 0;
5881
5882 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
5883
5884 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5885 {
5886 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
5887 continue;
5888
5889 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
5890 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5891 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5892 {
5893 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5894 found = 1;
5895 }
5896 }
5897
5898 if (found)
5899 breakpoint_re_set ();
5900 }
5901
5902
5903 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
5904 at address specified by SAL.
5905 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
5906
5907 struct breakpoint *
5908 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
5909 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
5910 {
5911 struct breakpoint *b;
5912
5913 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
5914 one. */
5915 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
5916
5917 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
5918 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5919 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5920 b->frame_id = frame_id;
5921
5922 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
5923 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
5924 single thread of control. */
5925 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
5926 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
5927
5928 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5929
5930 return b;
5931 }
5932
5933 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
5934 ORIG is NULL. */
5935
5936 struct breakpoint *
5937 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
5938 {
5939 struct breakpoint *copy;
5940
5941 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
5942 if (orig == NULL)
5943 return NULL;
5944
5945 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
5946 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
5947 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
5948
5949 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
5950 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
5951 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
5952 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
5953 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
5954
5955 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
5956 copy->source_file = NULL;
5957 else
5958 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
5959
5960 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
5961 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
5962 copy->thread = orig->thread;
5963 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
5964
5965 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5966 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
5967 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
5968
5969 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
5970 return copy;
5971 }
5972
5973 struct breakpoint *
5974 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
5975 enum bptype type)
5976 {
5977 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5978
5979 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
5980 sal.pc = pc;
5981 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
5982 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
5983
5984 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
5985 }
5986 \f
5987
5988 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
5989
5990 static void
5991 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
5992 {
5993 int say_where = 0;
5994 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
5995 struct value_print_options opts;
5996
5997 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5998
5999 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6000 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6001 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6002 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6003 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6004
6005 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6006 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6007 else
6008 switch (b->type)
6009 {
6010 case bp_none:
6011 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6012 break;
6013 case bp_watchpoint:
6014 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6015 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6016 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6017 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6018 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6019 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6020 break;
6021 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6022 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6023 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6024 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6025 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6026 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6027 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6028 break;
6029 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6030 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6031 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6032 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6033 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6034 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6035 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6036 break;
6037 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6038 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6039 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6040 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6041 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6042 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6043 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6044 break;
6045 case bp_breakpoint:
6046 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6047 {
6048 say_where = 0;
6049 break;
6050 }
6051 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6052 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6053 else
6054 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6055 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6056 say_where = 1;
6057 break;
6058 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6059 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6060 {
6061 say_where = 0;
6062 break;
6063 }
6064 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6065 say_where = 1;
6066 break;
6067 case bp_tracepoint:
6068 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6069 {
6070 say_where = 0;
6071 break;
6072 }
6073 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6074 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6075 say_where = 1;
6076 break;
6077
6078 case bp_until:
6079 case bp_finish:
6080 case bp_longjmp:
6081 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6082 case bp_step_resume:
6083 case bp_call_dummy:
6084 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6085 case bp_shlib_event:
6086 case bp_thread_event:
6087 case bp_overlay_event:
6088 case bp_jit_event:
6089 case bp_longjmp_master:
6090 break;
6091 }
6092
6093 if (say_where)
6094 {
6095 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6096 single string. */
6097 if (b->loc == NULL)
6098 {
6099 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6100 }
6101 else
6102 {
6103 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6104 {
6105 printf_filtered (" at ");
6106 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6107 gdb_stdout);
6108 }
6109 if (b->source_file)
6110 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6111 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6112
6113 if (b->loc->next)
6114 {
6115 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6116 int n = 0;
6117 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6118 ++n;
6119 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6120 }
6121
6122 }
6123 }
6124 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6125 return;
6126 printf_filtered ("\n");
6127 }
6128 \f
6129
6130 static struct bp_location *
6131 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6132 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6133 {
6134 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6135
6136 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6137 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6138 ;
6139 *tmp = loc;
6140 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6141 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6142 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6143 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6144 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6145 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6146 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6147 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6148 loc->section = sal->section;
6149
6150 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6151 return loc;
6152 }
6153 \f
6154
6155 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6156 return 0 otherwise. */
6157
6158 static int
6159 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6160 {
6161 int len;
6162 CORE_ADDR addr;
6163 const gdb_byte *brk;
6164 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6165 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6166 int retval = 0;
6167
6168 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6169
6170 addr = loc->address;
6171 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6172
6173 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6174 if (brk == NULL)
6175 return 0;
6176
6177 target_mem = alloca (len);
6178
6179 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6180 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6181 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6182 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6183
6184 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6185 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6186
6187 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6188 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6189 retval = 1;
6190
6191 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6192
6193 return retval;
6194 }
6195
6196
6197
6198 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6199 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6200 as condition expression. */
6201
6202 static void
6203 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6204 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6205 char *cond_string,
6206 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6207 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6208 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6209 {
6210 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6211 int i;
6212
6213 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6214 {
6215 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6216 int target_resources_ok =
6217 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6218 i + 1, 0);
6219 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6220 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6221 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6222 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6223 }
6224
6225 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6226
6227 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6228 {
6229 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6230 struct bp_location *loc;
6231
6232 if (from_tty)
6233 {
6234 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6235 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6236 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6237
6238 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6239 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6240 }
6241
6242 if (i == 0)
6243 {
6244 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6245 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6246 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6247 b->thread = thread;
6248 b->task = task;
6249
6250 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6251 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6252 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6253 b->disposition = disposition;
6254
6255 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6256
6257 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6258 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6259 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6260 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6261
6262 loc = b->loc;
6263 }
6264 else
6265 {
6266 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6267 }
6268
6269 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6270 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6271
6272 if (b->cond_string)
6273 {
6274 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6275 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6276 if (*arg)
6277 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6278 }
6279 }
6280
6281 if (addr_string)
6282 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6283 else
6284 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6285 me. */
6286 b->addr_string
6287 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6288
6289 b->ops = ops;
6290 mention (b);
6291 }
6292
6293 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6294 elements to fill the void space. */
6295 static void
6296 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6297 {
6298 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6299 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6300
6301 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6302 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6303
6304 --(sal->nelts);
6305 }
6306
6307 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6308 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6309 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6310 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6311 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6312 single expanded sal, return the original.
6313
6314 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6315 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6316 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6317 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6318 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6319
6320 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6321 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6322 {
6323 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6324 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6325 char *original_function = NULL;
6326 int found;
6327 int i;
6328 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6329
6330 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6331 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6332 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6333 {
6334 expanded.nelts = 1;
6335 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6336 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6337 return expanded;
6338 }
6339
6340 sal.pc = 0;
6341
6342 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6343
6344 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6345
6346 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6347
6348 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6349 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6350
6351 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6352 {
6353 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6354 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6355 xfree (expanded.sals);
6356 expanded.nelts = 1;
6357 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6358 sal.pc = original_pc;
6359 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6360 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6361 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6362 return expanded;
6363 }
6364
6365 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6366 {
6367 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6368 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6369 {
6370 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6371 char *this_function;
6372
6373 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6374 read memory. */
6375 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6376
6377 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6378 &func_addr, &func_end))
6379 {
6380 if (this_function
6381 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6382 {
6383 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6384 --i;
6385 }
6386 else if (func_addr == pc)
6387 {
6388 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6389 skip prologue. */
6390 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6391 if (sym)
6392 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6393 else
6394 {
6395 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6396 we should really always find the section here. */
6397 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6398 if (section)
6399 {
6400 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6401 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6402 expanded.sals[i].pc
6403 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6404 }
6405 }
6406 }
6407 }
6408 }
6409 }
6410 else
6411 {
6412 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6413 {
6414 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6415 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6416 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6417 }
6418 }
6419
6420 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6421
6422 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6423 {
6424 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6425 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6426 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6427 xfree (expanded.sals);
6428 expanded.nelts = 1;
6429 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6430 sal.pc = original_pc;
6431 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6432 return expanded;
6433 }
6434
6435 if (original_pc)
6436 {
6437 found = 0;
6438 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6439 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6440 {
6441 found = 1;
6442 break;
6443 }
6444 gdb_assert (found);
6445 }
6446
6447 return expanded;
6448 }
6449
6450 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6451 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6452 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6453 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6454 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6455 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6456 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6457 we take just a single condition string.
6458
6459 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6460 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6461 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6462 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6463 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6464
6465 static void
6466 create_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6467 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6468 char *cond_string,
6469 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6470 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6471 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6472 int enabled)
6473 {
6474 int i;
6475 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6476 {
6477 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6478 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6479
6480 create_breakpoint (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6481 cond_string, type, disposition,
6482 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6483 }
6484 }
6485
6486 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6487 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6488 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6489 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6490
6491 static void
6492 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6493 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6494 char ***addr_string,
6495 int *not_found_ptr)
6496 {
6497 char *addr_start = *address;
6498 *addr_string = NULL;
6499 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6500 breakpoint. */
6501 if ((*address) == NULL
6502 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6503 {
6504 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6505 {
6506 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6507 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6508 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6509 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6510 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6511 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6512 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6513 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6514 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6515
6516 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6517 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6518 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6519 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6520 */
6521 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6522
6523 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6524 sals->nelts = 1;
6525 }
6526 else
6527 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6528 }
6529 else
6530 {
6531 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6532 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6533 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6534 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6535 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6536 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6537
6538 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6539
6540 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6541 && (!cursal.symtab
6542 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6543 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6544 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6545 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6546 not_found_ptr);
6547 else
6548 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6549 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6550 }
6551 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6552 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6553 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6554 if (addr_start != (*address))
6555 {
6556 int i;
6557 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6558 {
6559 /* Add the string if not present. */
6560 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6561 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6562 }
6563 }
6564 }
6565
6566
6567 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6568 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6569
6570 static void
6571 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6572 char *address)
6573 {
6574 int i;
6575 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6576 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6577 }
6578
6579 static void
6580 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6581 {
6582 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6583
6584 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6585 args->not_found_ptr);
6586 }
6587
6588 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6589 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6590 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6591 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6592 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6593 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6594 static void
6595 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6596 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6597 {
6598 *cond_string = NULL;
6599 *thread = -1;
6600 while (tok && *tok)
6601 {
6602 char *end_tok;
6603 int toklen;
6604 char *cond_start = NULL;
6605 char *cond_end = NULL;
6606 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6607 tok++;
6608
6609 end_tok = tok;
6610
6611 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6612 end_tok++;
6613
6614 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6615
6616 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6617 {
6618 struct expression *expr;
6619
6620 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6621 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6622 xfree (expr);
6623 cond_end = tok;
6624 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6625 cond_end - cond_start);
6626 }
6627 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6628 {
6629 char *tmptok;
6630
6631 tok = end_tok + 1;
6632 tmptok = tok;
6633 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6634 if (tok == tmptok)
6635 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6636 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6637 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6638 }
6639 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6640 {
6641 char *tmptok;
6642
6643 tok = end_tok + 1;
6644 tmptok = tok;
6645 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6646 if (tok == tmptok)
6647 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6648 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6649 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6650 }
6651 else
6652 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6653 }
6654 }
6655
6656 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between
6657 CLI and MI functions for setting a breakpoint.
6658 This function has two major modes of operations,
6659 selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD parameter.
6660 If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6661 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise,
6662 ARG is just the location of breakpoint, with condition
6663 and thread specified by the COND_STRING and THREAD
6664 parameters. */
6665
6666 static void
6667 break_command_really (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6668 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6669 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6670 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6671 int ignore_count,
6672 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6673 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6674 int from_tty,
6675 int enabled)
6676 {
6677 struct gdb_exception e;
6678 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6679 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6680 char *copy_arg;
6681 char *err_msg;
6682 char *addr_start = arg;
6683 char **addr_string;
6684 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6685 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6686 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6687 int i;
6688 int pending = 0;
6689 int not_found = 0;
6690 enum bptype type_wanted;
6691 int task = 0;
6692
6693 sals.sals = NULL;
6694 sals.nelts = 0;
6695 addr_string = NULL;
6696
6697 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6698 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6699 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6700 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6701
6702 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6703 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6704
6705 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6706 switch (e.reason)
6707 {
6708 case RETURN_QUIT:
6709 throw_exception (e);
6710 case RETURN_ERROR:
6711 switch (e.error)
6712 {
6713 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
6714
6715 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
6716 error. */
6717
6718 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
6719 throw_exception (e);
6720
6721 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
6722
6723 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
6724 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
6725 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
6726 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
6727 return;
6728
6729 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
6730 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
6731 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
6732 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
6733 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
6734 addr_string = &copy_arg;
6735 sals.nelts = 1;
6736 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
6737 pending_sal.pc = 0;
6738 pending = 1;
6739 break;
6740 default:
6741 throw_exception (e);
6742 }
6743 default:
6744 if (!sals.nelts)
6745 return;
6746 }
6747
6748 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
6749 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6750
6751 if (!pending)
6752 {
6753 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
6754 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
6755
6756 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
6757 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
6758 }
6759
6760 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
6761 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
6762 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
6763 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
6764 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
6765
6766 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
6767 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
6768 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
6769 {
6770 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
6771 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
6772 }
6773
6774 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
6775 are ok for the target. */
6776 if (!pending)
6777 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
6778
6779 type_wanted = (traceflag
6780 ? bp_tracepoint
6781 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
6782
6783 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
6784 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
6785 breakpoint. */
6786 if (!pending)
6787 {
6788 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
6789 {
6790 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
6791 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
6792 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
6793 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
6794 cond_string = NULL;
6795 thread = -1;
6796 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
6797 &thread, &task);
6798 if (cond_string)
6799 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6800 }
6801 else
6802 {
6803 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
6804 if (cond_string)
6805 {
6806 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
6807 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
6808 }
6809 }
6810 create_breakpoints (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string, type_wanted,
6811 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
6812 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6813 }
6814 else
6815 {
6816 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
6817 struct breakpoint *b;
6818
6819 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
6820
6821 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
6822 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6823 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6824 b->thread = -1;
6825 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
6826 b->cond_string = NULL;
6827 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6828 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6829 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
6830 b->ops = ops;
6831 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6832 b->pspace = current_program_space;
6833
6834 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6835 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6836 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6837 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6838
6839 mention (b);
6840 }
6841
6842 if (sals.nelts > 1)
6843 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
6844 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
6845 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
6846 breakpoint. */
6847 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6848 /* But cleanup everything else. */
6849 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6850
6851 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
6852 update_global_location_list (1);
6853 }
6854
6855 /* Set a breakpoint.
6856 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
6857 condition, and thread.
6858 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
6859 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
6860 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
6861
6862 static void
6863 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
6864 {
6865 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
6866 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
6867
6868 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
6869 arg,
6870 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
6871 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6872 0 /* Ignore count */,
6873 pending_break_support,
6874 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
6875 from_tty,
6876 1 /* enabled */);
6877 }
6878
6879
6880 void
6881 set_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6882 char *address, char *condition,
6883 int hardwareflag, int tempflag,
6884 int thread, int ignore_count,
6885 int pending, int enabled)
6886 {
6887 break_command_really (gdbarch,
6888 address, condition, thread,
6889 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
6890 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
6891 ignore_count,
6892 pending
6893 ? AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE : AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE,
6894 NULL, 0, enabled);
6895 }
6896
6897 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
6898 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
6899 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
6900 not modified.
6901
6902 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
6903
6904 static void
6905 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6906 {
6907 struct symbol *sym;
6908 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
6909 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6910
6911 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6912
6913 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
6914 if (sym != NULL)
6915 {
6916 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6917 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
6918 {
6919 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
6920 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
6921 *sal = start_sal;
6922 }
6923 }
6924
6925 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6926 }
6927
6928 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
6929
6930 void
6931 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6932 {
6933 CORE_ADDR pc;
6934
6935 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6936 {
6937 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
6938 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
6939 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
6940 sal->pc = pc;
6941
6942 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
6943 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6944 if (sal->explicit_line)
6945 {
6946 /* Preserve the original line number. */
6947 int saved_line = sal->line;
6948 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
6949 sal->line = saved_line;
6950 }
6951 }
6952
6953 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
6954 {
6955 struct blockvector *bv;
6956 struct block *b;
6957 struct symbol *sym;
6958
6959 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
6960 if (bv != NULL)
6961 {
6962 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
6963 if (sym != NULL)
6964 {
6965 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
6966 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
6967 }
6968 else
6969 {
6970 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
6971 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
6972 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
6973 source). */
6974
6975 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
6976 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6977
6978 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
6979
6980 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
6981 if (msym)
6982 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
6983
6984 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6985 }
6986 }
6987 }
6988 }
6989
6990 void
6991 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6992 {
6993 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
6994 }
6995
6996 void
6997 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
6998 {
6999 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7000 }
7001
7002 static void
7003 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7004 {
7005 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7006 }
7007
7008 static void
7009 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7010 {
7011 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7012 }
7013
7014 static void
7015 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7016 {
7017 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7018 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7019 stop at <line>\n"));
7020 }
7021
7022 static void
7023 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7024 {
7025 int badInput = 0;
7026
7027 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7028 badInput = 1;
7029 else if (*arg != '*')
7030 {
7031 char *argptr = arg;
7032 int hasColon = 0;
7033
7034 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7035 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7036 function/method name */
7037 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7038 {
7039 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7040 argptr++;
7041 }
7042
7043 if (hasColon)
7044 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7045 else
7046 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7047 }
7048
7049 if (badInput)
7050 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7051 else
7052 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7053 }
7054
7055 static void
7056 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7057 {
7058 int badInput = 0;
7059
7060 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7061 badInput = 1;
7062 else
7063 {
7064 char *argptr = arg;
7065 int hasColon = 0;
7066
7067 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7068 it is probably a line number. */
7069 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7070 {
7071 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7072 argptr++;
7073 }
7074
7075 if (hasColon)
7076 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7077 else
7078 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7079 }
7080
7081 if (badInput)
7082 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7083 else
7084 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7085 }
7086
7087 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7088 hw_read: watch read,
7089 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7090 static void
7091 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7092 {
7093 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7094 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7095 struct expression *exp;
7096 struct block *exp_valid_block;
7097 struct value *val, *mark;
7098 struct frame_info *frame;
7099 char *exp_start = NULL;
7100 char *exp_end = NULL;
7101 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7102 int toklen;
7103 char *cond_start = NULL;
7104 char *cond_end = NULL;
7105 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7106 enum bptype bp_type;
7107 int mem_cnt = 0;
7108 int thread = -1;
7109
7110 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7111 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7112 {
7113 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7114
7115 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7116 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7117
7118 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7119 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7120 be the thread identifier. */
7121 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7122 tok--;
7123 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7124 tok--;
7125
7126 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7127 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7128
7129 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7130 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7131 reach a "thread" token. */
7132 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7133 tok--;
7134
7135 end_tok = tok;
7136
7137 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7138 tok--;
7139
7140 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7141 calculate the length of the token. */
7142 tok++;
7143 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7144
7145 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7146 {
7147 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7148 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7149 only in a specific thread. */
7150 char *endp;
7151
7152 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7153 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7154
7155 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7156 thread ID. */
7157 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7158 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7159
7160 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7161 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7162 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7163
7164 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7165 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7166 evaluate_expression() function. */
7167 *tok = '\0';
7168 }
7169 }
7170
7171 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7172 innermost_block = NULL;
7173 exp_start = arg;
7174 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7175 exp_end = arg;
7176 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7177 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7178 prettier. */
7179 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7180 --exp_end;
7181
7182 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7183 mark = value_mark ();
7184 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7185 if (val != NULL)
7186 release_value (val);
7187
7188 tok = arg;
7189 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7190 tok++;
7191 end_tok = tok;
7192
7193 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7194 end_tok++;
7195
7196 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7197 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7198 {
7199 struct expression *cond;
7200
7201 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7202 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7203 xfree (cond);
7204 cond_end = tok;
7205 }
7206 if (*tok)
7207 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7208
7209 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7210 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7211 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7212 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7213 else
7214 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7215
7216 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7217 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7218 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7219 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7220 {
7221 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7222 target_resources_ok =
7223 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7224 other_type_used);
7225 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7226 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7227
7228 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7229 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7230 }
7231
7232 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7233 watchpoint could not be set. */
7234 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7235 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7236
7237 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7238
7239 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7240 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7241 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7242 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7243 if (innermost_block && frame)
7244 {
7245 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7246 {
7247 scope_breakpoint
7248 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7249 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7250 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7251
7252 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7253
7254 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7255 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7256
7257 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7258 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7259
7260 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7261 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7262 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7263 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7264 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7265 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7266 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7267 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7268 scope_breakpoint->type);
7269 }
7270 }
7271
7272 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7273 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7274 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7275 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7276 b->thread = thread;
7277 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7278 b->exp = exp;
7279 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7280 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7281 b->val = val;
7282 b->val_valid = 1;
7283 if (cond_start)
7284 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7285 else
7286 b->cond_string = 0;
7287
7288 if (frame)
7289 {
7290 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7291 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7292 }
7293 else
7294 {
7295 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7296 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7297 }
7298
7299 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7300 {
7301 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7302 need to act on them together. */
7303 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7304 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7305 }
7306
7307 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7308
7309 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7310 that should be inserted. */
7311 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7312
7313 mention (b);
7314 update_global_location_list (1);
7315 }
7316
7317 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7318 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7319 in hardware return zero. */
7320
7321 static int
7322 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7323 {
7324 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7325 struct value *head = v;
7326
7327 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7328 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7329 return 0;
7330
7331 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7332 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7333 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7334 hardware watchpoint.
7335
7336 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7337 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7338 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7339 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7340 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7341 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7342 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7343 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7344 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7345
7346 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7347 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7348 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7349 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7350 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7351 {
7352 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7353 {
7354 if (value_lazy (v))
7355 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7356 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7357 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7358 ;
7359 else
7360 {
7361 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7362 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7363 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7364
7365 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7366 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7367 middle of some value chain. */
7368 if (v == head
7369 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7370 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7371 {
7372 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7373 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7374
7375 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7376 return 0;
7377 else
7378 found_memory_cnt++;
7379 }
7380 }
7381 }
7382 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7383 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7384 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7385 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7386 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7387 }
7388
7389 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7390 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7391 return found_memory_cnt;
7392 }
7393
7394 void
7395 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7396 {
7397 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7398 }
7399
7400 static void
7401 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7402 {
7403 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7404 }
7405
7406 void
7407 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7408 {
7409 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7410 }
7411
7412 static void
7413 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7414 {
7415 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7416 }
7417
7418 void
7419 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7420 {
7421 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7422 }
7423
7424 static void
7425 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7426 {
7427 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7428 }
7429 \f
7430
7431 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7432 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7433
7434 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7435 {
7436 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7437 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7438 };
7439
7440 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7441 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7442 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7443 command. */
7444 static void
7445 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7446 {
7447 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7448
7449 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7450 if (a->breakpoint2)
7451 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7452 }
7453
7454 void
7455 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7456 {
7457 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7458 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7459 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7460 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7461 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7462 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7463
7464 clear_proceed_status ();
7465
7466 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7467 this function */
7468
7469 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7470 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7471 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7472 else
7473 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7474 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7475
7476 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7477 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7478
7479 sal = sals.sals[0];
7480 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7481
7482 if (*arg)
7483 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7484
7485 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7486
7487 if (anywhere)
7488 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7489 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7490 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7491 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7492 else
7493 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7494 at the very same frame. */
7495 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7496 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7497 bp_until);
7498
7499 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7500
7501 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7502 one. */
7503
7504 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7505 {
7506 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7507 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7508 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7509 sal,
7510 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7511 bp_until);
7512 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7513 }
7514
7515 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7516
7517 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7518 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7519 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7520 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7521
7522 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7523 {
7524 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7525 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7526
7527 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7528 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7529
7530 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7531 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7532 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7533 xfree);
7534 }
7535 else
7536 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7537 }
7538
7539 static void
7540 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7541 {
7542 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7543 return;
7544 while (isspace (**s))
7545 *s += 1;
7546 }
7547
7548 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7549 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7550
7551 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7552 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7553 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7554 if clause in the arg string. */
7555
7556 static char *
7557 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7558 {
7559 char *cond_string;
7560
7561 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7562 return NULL;
7563
7564 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7565 (*arg) += 2;
7566
7567 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7568 condition string. */
7569 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7570 cond_string = *arg;
7571
7572 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7573 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7574
7575 return cond_string;
7576 }
7577
7578 /* This function attempts to parse an optional filename from the arg
7579 string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7580
7581 Else, it returns a pointer to the parsed filename. (This function
7582 makes no attempt to verify that a file of that name exists, or is
7583 accessible.) And, it updates arg to point to the first character
7584 following the parsed filename in the arg string.
7585
7586 Note that clients needing to preserve the returned filename for
7587 future access should copy it to their own buffers. */
7588 static char *
7589 ep_parse_optional_filename (char **arg)
7590 {
7591 static char filename[1024];
7592 char *arg_p = *arg;
7593 int i;
7594 char c;
7595
7596 if ((*arg_p == '\0') || isspace (*arg_p))
7597 return NULL;
7598
7599 for (i = 0;; i++)
7600 {
7601 c = *arg_p;
7602 if (isspace (c))
7603 c = '\0';
7604 filename[i] = c;
7605 if (c == '\0')
7606 break;
7607 arg_p++;
7608 }
7609 *arg = arg_p;
7610
7611 return filename;
7612 }
7613
7614 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7615 process start/exit, etc. */
7616
7617 typedef enum
7618 {
7619 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7620 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7621 }
7622 catch_fork_kind;
7623
7624 static void
7625 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7626 {
7627 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7628 char *cond_string = NULL;
7629 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7630 int tempflag;
7631
7632 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7633 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7634 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7635
7636 if (!arg)
7637 arg = "";
7638 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7639
7640 /* The allowed syntax is:
7641 catch [v]fork
7642 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7643
7644 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7645 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7646
7647 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7648 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7649
7650 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7651 and enable reporting of such events. */
7652 switch (fork_kind)
7653 {
7654 case catch_fork_temporary:
7655 case catch_fork_permanent:
7656 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7657 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7658 break;
7659 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7660 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7661 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7662 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7663 break;
7664 default:
7665 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7666 break;
7667 }
7668 }
7669
7670 static void
7671 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7672 {
7673 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7674 int tempflag;
7675 char *cond_string = NULL;
7676
7677 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7678
7679 if (!arg)
7680 arg = "";
7681 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7682
7683 /* The allowed syntax is:
7684 catch exec
7685 catch exec if <cond>
7686
7687 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7688 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7689
7690 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7691 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7692
7693 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7694 and enable reporting of such events. */
7695 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7696 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7697 }
7698
7699 static enum print_stop_action
7700 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7701 {
7702 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7703
7704 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7705
7706 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7707 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7708 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7709 b->loc->address,
7710 b->number, 1);
7711 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7712 ui_out_text (uiout,
7713 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7714 : "Catchpoint ");
7715 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7716 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7717 ui_out_text (uiout,
7718 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7719 : " (exception caught), ");
7720 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7721 {
7722 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7723 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7724 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7725 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7726 }
7727 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7728 }
7729
7730 static void
7731 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7732 {
7733 struct value_print_options opts;
7734 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7735 if (opts.addressprint)
7736 {
7737 annotate_field (4);
7738 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7739 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7740 else
7741 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7742 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7743 }
7744 annotate_field (5);
7745 if (b->loc)
7746 *last_loc = b->loc;
7747 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
7748 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
7749 else
7750 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
7751 }
7752
7753 static void
7754 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7755 {
7756 int bp_temp;
7757 int bp_throw;
7758
7759 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7760 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7761 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
7762 : _("Catchpoint "));
7763 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7764 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
7765 : _(" (catch)"));
7766 }
7767
7768 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
7769 NULL, /* insert */
7770 NULL, /* remove */
7771 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
7772 print_exception_catchpoint,
7773 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
7774 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
7775 };
7776
7777 static int
7778 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
7779 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
7780 {
7781 char *trigger_func_name;
7782
7783 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7784 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
7785 else
7786 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
7787
7788 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
7789 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
7790 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
7791 tempflag, 0, 0,
7792 0,
7793 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
7794 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
7795 1 /* enabled */);
7796
7797 return 1;
7798 }
7799
7800 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
7801
7802 static void
7803 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
7804 int tempflag, int from_tty)
7805 {
7806 char *cond_string = NULL;
7807 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
7808
7809 if (!arg)
7810 arg = "";
7811 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7812
7813 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7814
7815 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7816 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7817
7818 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
7819 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
7820 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
7821
7822 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
7823 return;
7824
7825 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
7826 }
7827
7828 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
7829
7830 static void
7831 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7832 {
7833 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7834 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7835 }
7836
7837 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
7838
7839 static void
7840 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7841 {
7842 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7843 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
7844 }
7845
7846 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
7847
7848 static void
7849 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7850 struct symtab_and_line sal,
7851 char *addr_string,
7852 char *exp_string,
7853 char *cond_string,
7854 struct expression *cond,
7855 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7856 int tempflag,
7857 int from_tty)
7858 {
7859 struct breakpoint *b;
7860
7861 if (from_tty)
7862 {
7863 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7864 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7865 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7866
7867 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7868 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
7869 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
7870 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
7871 used for different exception names will use the same address.
7872 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
7873 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
7874 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
7875 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
7876 enough for now, though. */
7877 }
7878
7879 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
7880 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7881
7882 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7883 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7884 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7885 b->ignore_count = 0;
7886 b->loc->cond = cond;
7887 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7888 b->language = language_ada;
7889 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7890 b->exp_string = exp_string;
7891 b->thread = -1;
7892 b->ops = ops;
7893
7894 mention (b);
7895 update_global_location_list (1);
7896 }
7897
7898 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
7899
7900 static void
7901 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
7902 struct cmd_list_element *command)
7903 {
7904 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7905 int tempflag;
7906 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7907 enum bptype type;
7908 char *addr_string = NULL;
7909 char *exp_string = NULL;
7910 char *cond_string = NULL;
7911 struct expression *cond = NULL;
7912 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
7913
7914 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7915
7916 if (!arg)
7917 arg = "";
7918 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
7919 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
7920 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
7921 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
7922 from_tty);
7923 }
7924
7925 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
7926 static void
7927 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
7928 {
7929 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
7930 VEC_free (int, iter);
7931 }
7932
7933 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
7934 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
7935 static VEC(int) *
7936 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
7937 {
7938 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
7939 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
7940
7941 while (*arg != '\0')
7942 {
7943 int i, syscall_number;
7944 char *endptr;
7945 char cur_name[128];
7946 struct syscall s;
7947
7948 /* Skip whitespace. */
7949 while (isspace (*arg))
7950 arg++;
7951
7952 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
7953 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
7954 cur_name[i] = '\0';
7955 arg += i;
7956
7957 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
7958 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
7959 if (*endptr == '\0')
7960 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
7961 else
7962 {
7963 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
7964 to a number. */
7965 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
7966
7967 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
7968 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
7969 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
7970 be caught. */
7971 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
7972 }
7973
7974 /* Ok, it's valid. */
7975 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
7976 }
7977
7978 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
7979 return result;
7980 }
7981
7982 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
7983
7984 static void
7985 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7986 {
7987 int tempflag;
7988 VEC(int) *filter;
7989 struct syscall s;
7990 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7991
7992 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
7993 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
7994 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
7995 this architeture yet."));
7996
7997 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7998
7999 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8000
8001 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8002 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8003 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8004 for his/her architecture. */
8005 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8006
8007 /* The allowed syntax is:
8008 catch syscall
8009 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8010
8011 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8012
8013 if (arg != NULL)
8014 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8015 else
8016 filter = NULL;
8017
8018 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8019 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8020 }
8021
8022 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8023
8024 static void
8025 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8026 {
8027 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8028 int tempflag;
8029 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8030 char *addr_string = NULL;
8031 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8032
8033 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8034
8035 if (!arg)
8036 arg = "";
8037 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8038 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8039 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8040 }
8041
8042 static void
8043 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8044 {
8045 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8046 }
8047 \f
8048
8049 static void
8050 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8051 {
8052 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8053 }
8054
8055 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8056
8057 static void
8058 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8059 {
8060 struct breakpoint *b;
8061 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8062 int ix;
8063 int default_match;
8064 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8065 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8066 int i;
8067
8068 if (arg)
8069 {
8070 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8071 default_match = 0;
8072 }
8073 else
8074 {
8075 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8076 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8077 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8078 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8079 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8080 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8081 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8082 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8083 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8084 error (_("No source file specified."));
8085
8086 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8087 sals.nelts = 1;
8088
8089 default_match = 1;
8090 }
8091
8092 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8093 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8094 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8095 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8096 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8097
8098 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8099 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8100 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8101 due to optimization, all in one block.
8102 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8103 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8104 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8105 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8106 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8107 to support that. */
8108
8109 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8110 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8111 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8112 one breakpoint. */
8113
8114 found = NULL;
8115 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8116 {
8117 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8118 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8119 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8120 or at default pc.
8121
8122 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8123
8124 0 1 pc
8125 1 1 pc _and_ line
8126 0 0 line
8127 1 0 <can't happen> */
8128
8129 sal = sals.sals[i];
8130
8131 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8132 'found'. */
8133 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8134 {
8135 int match = 0;
8136 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8137 if (b->type != bp_none
8138 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8139 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8140 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8141 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8142 {
8143 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8144 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8145 {
8146 int pc_match = sal.pc
8147 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8148 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8149 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8150 || loc->section == sal.section);
8151 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8152 && b->source_file != NULL
8153 && sal.symtab != NULL
8154 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8155 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8156 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8157 if (pc_match || line_match)
8158 {
8159 match = 1;
8160 break;
8161 }
8162 }
8163 }
8164
8165 if (match)
8166 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8167 }
8168 }
8169 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8170 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8171 {
8172 if (arg)
8173 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8174 else
8175 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8176 }
8177
8178 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8179 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8180 if (from_tty)
8181 {
8182 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8183 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8184 else
8185 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8186 }
8187 breakpoints_changed ();
8188
8189 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8190 {
8191 if (from_tty)
8192 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8193 delete_breakpoint (b);
8194 }
8195 if (from_tty)
8196 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8197 }
8198 \f
8199 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8200 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8201 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8202
8203 void
8204 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8205 {
8206 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8207
8208 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8209 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8210 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8211 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8212 && bs->stop)
8213 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8214
8215 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8216 {
8217 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8218 delete_breakpoint (b);
8219 }
8220 }
8221
8222 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8223 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8224 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8225 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8226 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8227
8228 static int
8229 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8230 {
8231 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8232 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8233 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8234 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8235
8236 if (a->address != b->address)
8237 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8238
8239 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8240 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8241 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8242
8243 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8244 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8245
8246 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8247 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8248 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8249
8250 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8251 }
8252
8253 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8254 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8255 the bp_location array. */
8256
8257 static void
8258 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8259 {
8260 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8261
8262 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8263 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8264
8265 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8266 {
8267 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8268
8269 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8270 continue;
8271
8272 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8273 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8274
8275 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8276 addr = bl->address - start;
8277 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8278 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8279
8280 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8281
8282 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8283 addr = end - bl->address;
8284 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8285 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8286 }
8287 }
8288
8289 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8290 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8291 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8292 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8293 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8294 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8295 returns true on them.
8296
8297 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8298 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8299 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8300 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8301 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8302 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8303
8304 static void
8305 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8306 {
8307 struct breakpoint *b;
8308 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8309 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8310
8311 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8312 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8313 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8314 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8315 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8316 once. */
8317 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8318 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8319 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8320 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8321
8322 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8323 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8324 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8325 unsigned old_location_count;
8326
8327 old_location = bp_location;
8328 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8329 bp_location = NULL;
8330 bp_location_count = 0;
8331 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8332
8333 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8334 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8335 bp_location_count++;
8336
8337 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8338 locp = bp_location;
8339 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8340 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8341 *locp++ = loc;
8342 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8343 bp_location_compare);
8344
8345 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8346
8347 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8348 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8349 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8350 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8351 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8352
8353 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8354 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8355
8356 locp = bp_location;
8357 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8358 old_locp++)
8359 {
8360 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8361 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8362
8363 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8364 have to free it. */
8365 int found_object = 0;
8366 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8367 int keep_in_target = 0;
8368 int removed = 0;
8369
8370 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8371 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8372 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8373 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8374 locp++;
8375
8376 for (loc2p = locp;
8377 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8378 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8379 loc2p++)
8380 {
8381 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8382 {
8383 found_object = 1;
8384 break;
8385 }
8386 }
8387
8388 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8389 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8390 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8391 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8392 inserted. */
8393
8394 if (old_loc->inserted)
8395 {
8396 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8397
8398 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8399 {
8400 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8401 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8402 keep_in_target = 1;
8403 }
8404 else
8405 {
8406 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8407 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8408 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8409
8410 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8411 {
8412 for (loc2p = locp;
8413 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8414 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8415 loc2p++)
8416 {
8417 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8418
8419 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8420 {
8421 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8422 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8423 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8424 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8425 {
8426 loc2->inserted = 1;
8427 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8428 keep_in_target = 1;
8429 break;
8430 }
8431 }
8432 }
8433 }
8434 }
8435
8436 if (!keep_in_target)
8437 {
8438 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8439 {
8440 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8441 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8442 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8443 succeed next time.
8444
8445 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8446 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8447 after calling us. */
8448 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8449 old_loc->owner->number);
8450 }
8451 removed = 1;
8452 }
8453 }
8454
8455 if (!found_object)
8456 {
8457 if (removed && non_stop
8458 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8459 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8460 {
8461 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8462 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8463 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8464 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8465 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8466 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8467 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8468 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8469 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8470 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8471 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8472 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8473 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8474 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8475 SIGTRAP.
8476
8477 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8478 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8479
8480 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8481 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8482 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8483 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8484 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8485 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8486 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8487 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8488 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8489 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8490 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8491 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8492 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8493 thread_count.
8494
8495 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8496 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8497 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8498 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8499
8500 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8501 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8502 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8503 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8504 traps we can no longer explain. */
8505
8506 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8507 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8508
8509 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8510 }
8511 else
8512 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8513 }
8514 }
8515
8516 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8517 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8518 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8519 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8520 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8521 are sorted first for the same address.
8522
8523 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8524 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8525
8526 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8527 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8528 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8529 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8530 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8531 {
8532 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8533 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8534
8535 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8536 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8537 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8538 || !loc->enabled
8539 || loc->shlib_disabled
8540 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b))
8541 continue;
8542
8543 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8544 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8545 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8546 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8547 "actually inserted"));
8548
8549 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8550 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8551 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8552 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8553 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8554 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8555 else
8556 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8557
8558 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8559 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8560 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8561 {
8562 *loc_first_p = loc;
8563 loc->duplicate = 0;
8564 continue;
8565 }
8566
8567 loc->duplicate = 1;
8568
8569 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8570 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8571 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8572 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8573 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8574 }
8575
8576 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8577 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8578 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8579 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8580
8581 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8582 }
8583
8584 void
8585 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8586 {
8587 struct bp_location *loc;
8588 int ix;
8589
8590 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8591 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8592 {
8593 free_bp_location (loc);
8594 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8595 --ix;
8596 }
8597 }
8598
8599 static void
8600 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8601 {
8602 struct gdb_exception e;
8603 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8604 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8605 }
8606
8607 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8608 static void
8609 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8610 {
8611 bpstat bs;
8612 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8613 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8614 {
8615 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8616 bs->old_val = NULL;
8617 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8618 }
8619 }
8620
8621 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8622 static int
8623 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8624 {
8625 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8626 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8627 return 0;
8628 }
8629
8630 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8631 structures. */
8632
8633 void
8634 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8635 {
8636 struct breakpoint *b;
8637 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8638
8639 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8640
8641 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8642 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8643
8644 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8645 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8646 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8647 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8648 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8649
8650 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8651 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8652 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8653 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8654 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8655 return;
8656
8657 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8658
8659 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8660 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8661
8662 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8663 if (b->next == bpt)
8664 {
8665 b->next = bpt->next;
8666 break;
8667 }
8668
8669 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8670 if (bpt->cond_string != NULL)
8671 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8672 if (bpt->addr_string != NULL)
8673 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8674 if (bpt->exp != NULL)
8675 xfree (bpt->exp);
8676 if (bpt->exp_string != NULL)
8677 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8678 if (bpt->val != NULL)
8679 value_free (bpt->val);
8680 if (bpt->source_file != NULL)
8681 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8682 if (bpt->exec_pathname != NULL)
8683 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8684 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8685
8686 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8687 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8688 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8689 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8690 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8691 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8692 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8693 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8694 with commands won't work. */
8695
8696 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8697
8698 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8699 list, update the global location list. This
8700 will remove locations that used to belong to
8701 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8702 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8703 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8704 design to have location completely self-contained,
8705 but it's not the case now. */
8706 update_global_location_list (0);
8707
8708
8709 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8710 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8711 bpt->type = bp_none;
8712
8713 xfree (bpt);
8714 }
8715
8716 static void
8717 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8718 {
8719 delete_breakpoint (b);
8720 }
8721
8722 struct cleanup *
8723 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8724 {
8725 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8726 }
8727
8728 void
8729 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8730 {
8731 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8732
8733 dont_repeat ();
8734
8735 if (arg == 0)
8736 {
8737 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
8738
8739 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
8740 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
8741 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
8742 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8743 {
8744 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8745 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8746 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8747 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8748 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8749 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8750 && b->number >= 0)
8751 {
8752 breaks_to_delete = 1;
8753 break;
8754 }
8755 }
8756
8757 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
8758 if (!from_tty
8759 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
8760 {
8761 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8762 {
8763 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
8764 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
8765 && b->type != bp_thread_event
8766 && b->type != bp_jit_event
8767 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
8768 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
8769 && b->number >= 0)
8770 delete_breakpoint (b);
8771 }
8772 }
8773 }
8774 else
8775 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
8776 }
8777
8778 static int
8779 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
8780 {
8781 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8782 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
8783 return 0;
8784 return 1;
8785 }
8786
8787 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
8788 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
8789 Null names are ignored. */
8790
8791 static int
8792 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
8793 {
8794 struct bp_location *l;
8795 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
8796 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
8797 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
8798
8799 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
8800 {
8801 const char **slot;
8802 const char *name = l->function_name;
8803
8804 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
8805 if (name == NULL)
8806 continue;
8807
8808 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
8809 INSERT);
8810 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
8811 NULL. */
8812 if (*slot != NULL)
8813 {
8814 htab_delete (htab);
8815 return 1;
8816 }
8817 *slot = name;
8818 }
8819
8820 htab_delete (htab);
8821 return 0;
8822 }
8823
8824 static void
8825 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
8826 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
8827 {
8828 int i;
8829 char *s;
8830 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
8831
8832 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
8833 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
8834 the common case where all locations are in the same
8835 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
8836 retain the location, so that when the library
8837 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
8838 status of the individual locations. */
8839 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
8840 return;
8841
8842 b->loc = NULL;
8843
8844 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
8845 {
8846 struct bp_location *new_loc =
8847 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
8848
8849 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
8850 old symtab. */
8851 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
8852 {
8853 struct gdb_exception e;
8854
8855 s = b->cond_string;
8856 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8857 {
8858 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
8859 0);
8860 }
8861 if (e.reason < 0)
8862 {
8863 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
8864 b->number, e.message);
8865 new_loc->enabled = 0;
8866 }
8867 }
8868
8869 if (b->source_file != NULL)
8870 xfree (b->source_file);
8871 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
8872 b->source_file = NULL;
8873 else
8874 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
8875
8876 if (b->line_number == 0)
8877 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
8878 }
8879
8880 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
8881 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
8882 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
8883
8884 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
8885 {
8886 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
8887 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
8888 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
8889 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
8890 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
8891 often enough until a better solution is found. */
8892 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
8893
8894 for (; e; e = e->next)
8895 {
8896 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
8897 {
8898 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
8899 if (have_ambiguous_names)
8900 {
8901 for (; l; l = l->next)
8902 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
8903 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
8904 {
8905 l->enabled = 0;
8906 break;
8907 }
8908 }
8909 else
8910 {
8911 for (; l; l = l->next)
8912 if (l->function_name
8913 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
8914 {
8915 l->enabled = 0;
8916 break;
8917 }
8918 }
8919 }
8920 }
8921 }
8922
8923 update_global_location_list (1);
8924 }
8925
8926
8927 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
8928 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
8929 Unused in this case. */
8930
8931 static int
8932 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
8933 {
8934 /* get past catch_errs */
8935 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
8936 struct value *mark;
8937 int i;
8938 int not_found = 0;
8939 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
8940 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
8941 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
8942 char *s;
8943 enum enable_state save_enable;
8944 struct gdb_exception e;
8945 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
8946
8947 switch (b->type)
8948 {
8949 case bp_none:
8950 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
8951 b->number);
8952 return 0;
8953 case bp_breakpoint:
8954 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
8955 case bp_tracepoint:
8956 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
8957 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
8958 return 0;
8959
8960 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
8961 {
8962 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
8963 delete_breakpoint (b);
8964 return 0;
8965 }
8966
8967 set_language (b->language);
8968 input_radix = b->input_radix;
8969 s = b->addr_string;
8970
8971 save_current_space_and_thread ();
8972 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
8973
8974 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8975 {
8976 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
8977 not_found_ptr);
8978 }
8979 if (e.reason < 0)
8980 {
8981 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
8982 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
8983 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
8984 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
8985 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
8986 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
8987 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
8988 if (not_found
8989 && (b->condition_not_parsed
8990 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
8991 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
8992 not_found_and_ok = 1;
8993
8994 if (!not_found_and_ok)
8995 {
8996 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
8997 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
8998 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
8999 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9000 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9001 which approach is better. */
9002 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9003 throw_exception (e);
9004 }
9005 }
9006
9007 if (!not_found)
9008 {
9009 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9010
9011 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9012 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9013 {
9014 char *cond_string = 0;
9015 int thread = -1;
9016 int task = 0;
9017
9018 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9019 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9020 if (cond_string)
9021 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9022 b->thread = thread;
9023 b->task = task;
9024 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9025 }
9026
9027 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9028 }
9029
9030 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9031 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9032 break;
9033
9034 case bp_watchpoint:
9035 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9036 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9037 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9038 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9039 or it can be on local variables.
9040
9041 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9042 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9043 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9044 and unloaded.
9045
9046 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9047 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9048 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9049 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9050 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9051 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9052
9053 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9054 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9055 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9056 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9057
9058 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9059 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9060
9061 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9062 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9063 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9064 break;
9065 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9066 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9067 loaded. */
9068 case bp_catchpoint:
9069 break;
9070
9071 default:
9072 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9073 /* fall through */
9074 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9075 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9076 case bp_overlay_event:
9077 case bp_longjmp_master:
9078 delete_breakpoint (b);
9079 break;
9080
9081 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9082 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9083 case bp_shlib_event:
9084
9085 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9086 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9087 case bp_thread_event:
9088
9089 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9090 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9091 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9092 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9093 case bp_until:
9094 case bp_finish:
9095 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9096 case bp_call_dummy:
9097 case bp_step_resume:
9098 case bp_longjmp:
9099 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9100 case bp_jit_event:
9101 break;
9102 }
9103
9104 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9105 return 0;
9106 }
9107
9108 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9109 void
9110 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9111 {
9112 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9113 enum language save_language;
9114 int save_input_radix;
9115 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9116
9117 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9118 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9119 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9120
9121 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9122 {
9123 /* Format possible error msg */
9124 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9125 b->number);
9126 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9127 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9128 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9129 }
9130 set_language (save_language);
9131 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9132
9133 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9134
9135 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9136
9137 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9138 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9139 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9140 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9141 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9142 }
9143 \f
9144 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9145
9146 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9147 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9148 void
9149 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9150 {
9151 if (b->thread != -1)
9152 {
9153 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9154 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9155
9156 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9157 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9158 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9159 as well. */
9160 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9161 }
9162 }
9163
9164 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9165 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9166 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9167
9168 void
9169 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9170 {
9171 struct breakpoint *b;
9172
9173 if (count < 0)
9174 count = 0;
9175
9176 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9177 if (b->number == bptnum)
9178 {
9179 b->ignore_count = count;
9180 if (from_tty)
9181 {
9182 if (count == 0)
9183 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9184 bptnum);
9185 else if (count == 1)
9186 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9187 bptnum);
9188 else
9189 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9190 count, bptnum);
9191 }
9192 breakpoints_changed ();
9193 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9194 return;
9195 }
9196
9197 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9198 }
9199
9200 void
9201 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9202 {
9203 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9204 b->silent = 1;
9205 }
9206
9207 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9208
9209 static void
9210 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9211 {
9212 char *p = args;
9213 int num;
9214
9215 if (p == 0)
9216 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9217
9218 num = get_number (&p);
9219 if (num == 0)
9220 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9221 if (*p == 0)
9222 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9223
9224 set_ignore_count (num,
9225 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9226 from_tty);
9227 if (from_tty)
9228 printf_filtered ("\n");
9229 }
9230 \f
9231 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9232 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9233
9234 static void
9235 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9236 {
9237 char *p = args;
9238 char *p1;
9239 int num;
9240 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9241 int match;
9242
9243 if (p == 0)
9244 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9245
9246 while (*p)
9247 {
9248 match = 0;
9249 p1 = p;
9250
9251 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9252 if (num == 0)
9253 {
9254 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9255 }
9256 else
9257 {
9258 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9259 if (b->number == num)
9260 {
9261 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9262 match = 1;
9263 function (b);
9264 if (related_breakpoint)
9265 function (related_breakpoint);
9266 break;
9267 }
9268 if (match == 0)
9269 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9270 }
9271 p = p1;
9272 }
9273 }
9274
9275 static struct bp_location *
9276 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9277 {
9278 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9279 char *p1;
9280 int bp_num;
9281 int loc_num;
9282 struct breakpoint *b;
9283 struct bp_location *loc;
9284
9285 *dot = '\0';
9286
9287 p1 = number;
9288 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9289 if (bp_num == 0)
9290 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9291
9292 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9293 if (b->number == bp_num)
9294 {
9295 break;
9296 }
9297
9298 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9299 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9300
9301 p1 = dot+1;
9302 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9303 if (loc_num == 0)
9304 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9305
9306 --loc_num;
9307 loc = b->loc;
9308 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9309 ;
9310 if (!loc)
9311 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9312
9313 return loc;
9314 }
9315
9316
9317 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9318 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9319 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9320
9321 void
9322 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9323 {
9324 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9325 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9326 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9327 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9328 return;
9329
9330 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9331 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9332 return;
9333
9334 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9335
9336 update_global_location_list (0);
9337
9338 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9339 }
9340
9341 static void
9342 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9343 {
9344 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9345 if (args == 0)
9346 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9347 switch (bpt->type)
9348 {
9349 case bp_none:
9350 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9351 bpt->number);
9352 continue;
9353 case bp_breakpoint:
9354 case bp_tracepoint:
9355 case bp_catchpoint:
9356 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9357 case bp_watchpoint:
9358 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9359 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9360 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9361 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9362 default:
9363 continue;
9364 }
9365 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9366 {
9367 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9368 if (loc)
9369 loc->enabled = 0;
9370 update_global_location_list (0);
9371 }
9372 else
9373 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9374 }
9375
9376 static void
9377 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9378 {
9379 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9380 struct value *mark;
9381
9382 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9383 {
9384 int i;
9385 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9386 target_resources_ok =
9387 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9388 i + 1, 0);
9389 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9390 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9391 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9392 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9393 }
9394
9395 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9396 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9397 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9398 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9399 {
9400 struct gdb_exception e;
9401
9402 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9403 {
9404 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9405 }
9406 if (e.reason < 0)
9407 {
9408 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9409 bpt->number);
9410 return;
9411 }
9412 }
9413
9414 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9415 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9416 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9417 update_global_location_list (1);
9418 breakpoints_changed ();
9419
9420 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9421 }
9422
9423
9424 void
9425 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9426 {
9427 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9428 }
9429
9430 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9431 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9432 in stopping the inferior. */
9433
9434 static void
9435 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9436 {
9437 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9438 if (args == 0)
9439 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9440 switch (bpt->type)
9441 {
9442 case bp_none:
9443 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9444 bpt->number);
9445 continue;
9446 case bp_breakpoint:
9447 case bp_tracepoint:
9448 case bp_catchpoint:
9449 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9450 case bp_watchpoint:
9451 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9452 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9453 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9454 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9455 default:
9456 continue;
9457 }
9458 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9459 {
9460 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9461 if (loc)
9462 loc->enabled = 1;
9463 update_global_location_list (1);
9464 }
9465 else
9466 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9467 }
9468
9469 static void
9470 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9471 {
9472 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9473 }
9474
9475 static void
9476 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9477 {
9478 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9479 }
9480
9481 static void
9482 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9483 {
9484 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9485 }
9486
9487 static void
9488 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9489 {
9490 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9491 }
9492 \f
9493 static void
9494 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9495 {
9496 }
9497
9498 static void
9499 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9500 {
9501 }
9502
9503 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9504 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9505 GDB itself. */
9506
9507 static void
9508 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9509 const bfd_byte *data)
9510 {
9511 struct breakpoint *bp;
9512
9513 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9514 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9515 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9516 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9517 {
9518 struct bp_location *loc;
9519
9520 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9521 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9522 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9523 && addr + len > loc->address)
9524 {
9525 value_free (bp->val);
9526 bp->val = NULL;
9527 bp->val_valid = 0;
9528 }
9529 }
9530 }
9531
9532 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9533
9534 struct symtabs_and_lines
9535 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9536 {
9537 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9538 if (string == 0)
9539 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9540 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9541 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9542 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9543 default_breakpoint_line,
9544 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9545 else
9546 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9547 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9548 if (*string)
9549 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9550 return sals;
9551 }
9552
9553 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9554 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9555 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9556 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9557 someday. */
9558
9559 void *
9560 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9561 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9562 {
9563 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9564
9565 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9566
9567 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9568 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9569
9570 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9571 {
9572 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9573 xfree (bp_tgt);
9574 return NULL;
9575 }
9576
9577 return bp_tgt;
9578 }
9579
9580 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9581
9582 int
9583 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9584 {
9585 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9586 int ret;
9587
9588 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9589 xfree (bp_tgt);
9590
9591 return ret;
9592 }
9593
9594 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9595
9596 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9597 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9598
9599 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9600
9601 void
9602 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9603 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9604 {
9605 void **bpt_p;
9606
9607 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9608 {
9609 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9610 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9611 }
9612 else
9613 {
9614 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9615 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9616 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9617 }
9618
9619 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9620 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9621 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9622 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9623 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9624 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9625
9626 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9627 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9628 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9629 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9630 }
9631
9632 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9633
9634 void
9635 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9636 {
9637 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9638
9639 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9640 call. */
9641 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9642 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9643 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9644 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9645
9646 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9647 {
9648 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9649 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9650 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9651 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9652 }
9653 }
9654
9655 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9656
9657 static int
9658 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9659 {
9660 int i;
9661
9662 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9663 {
9664 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9665 if (bp_tgt
9666 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9667 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9668 aspace, pc))
9669 return 1;
9670 }
9671
9672 return 0;
9673 }
9674
9675 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9676 non-zero otherwise. */
9677 static int
9678 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9679 {
9680 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9681 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9682 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9683 return 1;
9684 else
9685 return 0;
9686 }
9687
9688 int
9689 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9690 {
9691 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9692
9693 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9694 }
9695
9696 int
9697 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9698 {
9699 struct breakpoint *bp;
9700
9701 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9702 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9703 {
9704 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9705 {
9706 int i, iter;
9707 for (i = 0;
9708 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9709 i++)
9710 if (syscall_number == iter)
9711 return 1;
9712 }
9713 else
9714 return 1;
9715 }
9716
9717 return 0;
9718 }
9719
9720 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9721 static char **
9722 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9723 char *text, char *word)
9724 {
9725 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9726 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9727 }
9728
9729 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
9730
9731 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
9732 static void
9733 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
9734 {
9735 tracepoint_count = num;
9736 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
9737 }
9738
9739 void
9740 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9741 {
9742 break_command_really (get_current_arch (),
9743 arg,
9744 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
9745 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
9746 1 /* traceflag */,
9747 0 /* Ignore count */,
9748 pending_break_support,
9749 NULL,
9750 from_tty,
9751 1 /* enabled */);
9752 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
9753 }
9754
9755 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
9756 omitted. */
9757
9758 static void
9759 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
9760 {
9761 struct breakpoint *b;
9762 int tps_to_list = 0;
9763
9764 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
9765 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
9766 {
9767 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9768 {
9769 if (b->number >= 0)
9770 {
9771 tps_to_list = 1;
9772 break;
9773 }
9774 }
9775 if (!tps_to_list)
9776 {
9777 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
9778 return;
9779 }
9780 }
9781
9782 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
9783 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
9784 }
9785
9786 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
9787 Not supported by all targets. */
9788 static void
9789 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9790 {
9791 enable_command (args, from_tty);
9792 }
9793
9794 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
9795 Not supported by all targets. */
9796 static void
9797 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9798 {
9799 disable_command (args, from_tty);
9800 }
9801
9802 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
9803 static void
9804 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9805 {
9806 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9807
9808 dont_repeat ();
9809
9810 if (arg == 0)
9811 {
9812 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9813
9814 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9815 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9816 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9817 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
9818 {
9819 if (b->number >= 0)
9820 {
9821 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9822 break;
9823 }
9824 }
9825
9826 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9827 if (!from_tty
9828 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
9829 {
9830 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9831 {
9832 if (b->type == bp_tracepoint
9833 && b->number >= 0)
9834 delete_breakpoint (b);
9835 }
9836 }
9837 }
9838 else
9839 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9840 }
9841
9842 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
9843
9844 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
9845 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
9846 Also accepts special argument "all". */
9847
9848 static void
9849 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9850 {
9851 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
9852 unsigned int count;
9853 int all = 0;
9854
9855 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9856 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
9857
9858 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
9859
9860 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
9861 args++;
9862
9863 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
9864 {
9865 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
9866 all = 1;
9867 if (*args)
9868 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9869 }
9870 else
9871 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
9872
9873 do
9874 {
9875 if (t1)
9876 {
9877 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
9878 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
9879 {
9880 t2->pass_count = count;
9881 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
9882 if (from_tty)
9883 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
9884 t2->number, count);
9885 }
9886 if (! all && *args)
9887 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
9888 }
9889 }
9890 while (*args);
9891 }
9892
9893 struct breakpoint *
9894 get_tracepoint (int num)
9895 {
9896 struct breakpoint *t;
9897
9898 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9899 if (t->number == num)
9900 return t;
9901
9902 return NULL;
9903 }
9904
9905 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
9906 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
9907 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
9908 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
9909 struct breakpoint *
9910 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
9911 {
9912 extern int tracepoint_count;
9913 struct breakpoint *t;
9914 int tpnum;
9915 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
9916
9917 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
9918 {
9919 if (optional_p)
9920 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
9921 else
9922 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
9923 }
9924 else
9925 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
9926
9927 if (tpnum <= 0)
9928 {
9929 if (instring && *instring)
9930 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
9931 instring);
9932 else
9933 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
9934 return NULL;
9935 }
9936
9937 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
9938 if (t->number == tpnum)
9939 {
9940 return t;
9941 }
9942
9943 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
9944 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
9945 allow us to discover this. */
9946 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
9947 return NULL;
9948 }
9949
9950 /* save-tracepoints command */
9951 static void
9952 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9953 {
9954 struct breakpoint *tp;
9955 int any_tp = 0;
9956 struct action_line *line;
9957 FILE *fp;
9958 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
9959 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
9960 char tmp[40];
9961 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9962
9963 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
9964 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
9965
9966 /* See if we have anything to save. */
9967 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9968 {
9969 any_tp = 1;
9970 break;
9971 }
9972 if (!any_tp)
9973 {
9974 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
9975 return;
9976 }
9977
9978 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
9979 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
9980 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
9981 if (!fp)
9982 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
9983 args, safe_strerror (errno));
9984 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
9985
9986 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
9987 {
9988 if (tp->addr_string)
9989 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
9990 else
9991 {
9992 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
9993 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
9994 }
9995
9996 if (tp->pass_count)
9997 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
9998
9999 if (tp->actions)
10000 {
10001 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
10002 indent = i1;
10003 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10004 {
10005 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10006
10007 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10008 actionline = line->action;
10009 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10010 actionline++;
10011
10012 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10013 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10014 {
10015 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10016 if (cmd == 0)
10017 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10018 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10019 indent = i2;
10020 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10021 indent = i1;
10022 }
10023 }
10024 }
10025 }
10026 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10027 if (from_tty)
10028 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10029 return;
10030 }
10031
10032 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10033
10034 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10035 all_tracepoints ()
10036 {
10037 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10038 struct breakpoint *tp;
10039
10040 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10041 {
10042 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10043 }
10044
10045 return tp_vec;
10046 }
10047
10048 \f
10049 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10050 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10051 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10052 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10053 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10054 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10055 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10056 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10057 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10058 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10059 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10060 \n\
10061 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10062 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10063 \n\
10064 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10065 \n\
10066 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10067
10068 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10069 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10070
10071 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10072 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10073
10074 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10075 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10076 static void
10077 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10078 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10079 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10080 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10081 char *text, char *word),
10082 void *user_data_catch,
10083 void *user_data_tcatch)
10084 {
10085 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10086
10087 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10088 &catch_cmdlist);
10089 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10090 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10091 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10092
10093 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10094 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10095 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10096 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10097 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10098 }
10099
10100 static void
10101 clear_syscall_counts (int pid)
10102 {
10103 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
10104
10105 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10106 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10107 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10108 }
10109
10110 void
10111 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10112 {
10113 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10114 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10115 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10116
10117 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10118 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10119 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10120
10121 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10122 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10123 before a breakpoint is set. */
10124 breakpoint_count = 0;
10125
10126 tracepoint_count = 0;
10127
10128 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10129 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10130 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10131 if (xdb_commands)
10132 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10133
10134 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10135 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10136 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10137 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10138 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10139 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10140 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10141 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10142
10143 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10144 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10145 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10146 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10147
10148 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10149 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10150 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10151 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10152 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10153 \n"
10154 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10155 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10156
10157 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10158 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10159 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10160 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10161 \n"
10162 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10163 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10164
10165 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10166 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10167 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10168 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10169 \n"
10170 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10171 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10172
10173 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10174 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10175 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10176 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10177 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10178 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10179 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10180 if (xdb_commands)
10181 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10182 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10183 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10184 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10185 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10186 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10187
10188 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10189
10190 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10191 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10192 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10193 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10194 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10195 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10196
10197 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10198 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10199 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10200 &enablebreaklist);
10201
10202 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10203 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10204 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10205 &enablebreaklist);
10206
10207 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10208 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10209 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10210 &enablelist);
10211
10212 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10213 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10214 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10215 &enablelist);
10216
10217 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10218 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10219 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10220 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10221 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10222 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10223 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10224 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10225 if (xdb_commands)
10226 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10227 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10228 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10229 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10230 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10231
10232 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10233 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10234 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10235 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10236 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10237 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10238 &disablelist);
10239
10240 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10241 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10242 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10243 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10244 \n\
10245 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10246 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10247 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10248 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10249 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10250 if (xdb_commands)
10251 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10252 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10253 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10254 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10255
10256 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10257 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10258 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10259 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10260 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10261 &deletelist);
10262
10263 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10264 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10265 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10266 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10267 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10268 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10269 \n\
10270 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10271 is executing in.\n\
10272 \n\
10273 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10274
10275 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10276 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10277 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10278 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10279
10280 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10281 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10282 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10283 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10284
10285 if (xdb_commands)
10286 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10287
10288 if (dbx_commands)
10289 {
10290 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10291 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10292 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10293 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10294 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10295 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10296 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10297 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10298 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10299 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10300 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10301 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10302 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10303 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10304 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10305 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10306 \n\
10307 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10308 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10309 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10310 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10311 breakpoint set."));
10312 }
10313
10314 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10315 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10316 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10317 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10318 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10319 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10320 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10321 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10322 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10323 \n\
10324 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10325 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10326 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10327 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10328 breakpoint set."));
10329
10330 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10331
10332 if (xdb_commands)
10333 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10334 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10335 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10336 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10337 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10338 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10339 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10340 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10341 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10342 \n\
10343 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10344 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10345 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10346 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10347 breakpoint set."));
10348
10349 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10350 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10351 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10352 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10353 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10354 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10355 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10356 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10357 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10358 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10359 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10360 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10361 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10362 \n\
10363 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10364 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10365 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10366 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10367 breakpoint set."),
10368 &maintenanceinfolist);
10369
10370 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10371 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10372 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10373 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10374
10375 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10376 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10377 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10378 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10379
10380 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10381 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10382 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10383 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10384 catch_catch_command,
10385 NULL,
10386 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10387 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10388 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10389 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10390 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10391 catch_throw_command,
10392 NULL,
10393 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10394 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10395 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10396 catch_fork_command_1,
10397 NULL,
10398 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10399 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10400 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10401 catch_fork_command_1,
10402 NULL,
10403 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10404 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10405 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10406 catch_exec_command_1,
10407 NULL,
10408 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10409 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10410 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10411 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10412 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10413 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10414 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10415 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10416 catch_syscall_command_1,
10417 catch_syscall_completer,
10418 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10419 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10420 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10421 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10422 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10423 catch_ada_exception_command,
10424 NULL,
10425 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10426 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10427 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10428 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10429 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10430 catch_assert_command,
10431 NULL,
10432 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10433 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10434
10435 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10436 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10437 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10438 an expression changes."));
10439 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10440
10441 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10442 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10443 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10444 an expression is read."));
10445 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10446
10447 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10448 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10449 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10450 an expression is either read or written."));
10451 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10452
10453 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10454 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10455
10456
10457 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10458 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10459 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10460 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10461 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10462 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10463 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10464 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10465 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10466 hardware.)"),
10467 NULL,
10468 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10469 &setlist, &showlist);
10470
10471 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10472
10473 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10474
10475 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10476 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10477 \n"
10478 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10479 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10480 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10481
10482 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10483 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10484 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10485 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10486
10487 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10488 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10489 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10490 last tracepoint set."));
10491
10492 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10493
10494 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10495 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10496 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10497 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10498 &deletelist);
10499
10500 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10501 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10502 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10503 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10504 &disablelist);
10505 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10506
10507 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10508 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10509 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10510 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10511 &enablelist);
10512 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10513
10514 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10515 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10516 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10517 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10518 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10519
10520 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10521 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10522 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10523 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10524
10525 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10526 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10527 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10528 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10529 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10530 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10531 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10532 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10533 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10534 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10535 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10536 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10537
10538 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10539 &pending_break_support, _("\
10540 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10541 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10542 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10543 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10544 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10545 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10546 NULL,
10547 show_pending_break_support,
10548 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10549 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10550
10551 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10552
10553 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10554 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10555 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10556 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10557 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10558 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10559 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10560 NULL,
10561 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10562 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10563 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10564
10565 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10566 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10567 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10568 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10569 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10570 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10571 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10572 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10573 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10574 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10575 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10576 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10577 NULL,
10578 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10579 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10580 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10581
10582 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10583
10584 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10585 }